This application is based on Japanese Patent Application No. 2011-035086 filed (on Feb. 21, 2011) in Japan, the contents of which are hereby incorporated by reference.
The present invention relates to a precoding scheme, a precoding device, a transmission scheme, a transmission device, a reception scheme, and a reception device that in particular perform communication using a multi-antenna.
Multiple-Input Multiple-Output (MIMO) is a conventional example of a communication scheme using a multi-antenna. In multi-antenna communication, of which MIMO is representative, multiple transmission signals are each modulated, and each modulated signal is transmitted from a different antenna simultaneously in order to increase the transmission speed of data.
In this context, it has been suggested in Patent Literature 1 to use a transmission device provided with a different interleave pattern for each transmit antenna. In other words, the transmission device in
Models of actual propagation environments in wireless communications include non-line of sight (NLOS), of which a Rayleigh fading environment is representative, and line of sight (LOS), of which a Rician fading environment is representative. When the transmission device transmits a single modulated signal, and the reception device performs maximal ratio combining on the signals received by a plurality of antennas and then demodulates and decodes the signal resulting from maximal ratio combining, excellent reception quality can be achieved in an LOS environment, in particular in an environment where the Rician factor is large, which indicates the ratio of the received power of direct waves versus the received power of scattered waves. However, depending on the transmission system (for example, spatial multiplexing MIMO system), a problem occurs in that the reception quality deteriorates as the Rician factor increases (see Non-Patent Literature 3).
Broadcast or multicast communication is a service directed towards line-of-sight users. The radio wave propagation environment between the broadcasting station and the reception devices belonging to the users is often an LOS environment. When using a spatial multiplexing MIMO system having the above problem for broadcast or multicast communication, a situation may occur in which the received electric field strength is high at the reception device, but degradation in reception quality makes it impossible to receive the service. In other words, in order to use a spatial multiplexing MIMO system in broadcast or multicast communication in both an NLOS environment and an LOS environment, there is a desire for development of a MIMO system that offers a certain degree of reception quality.
Non-Patent Literature 8 describes a scheme to select a codebook used in precoding (i.e. a precoding matrix, also referred to as a precoding weight matrix) based on feedback information from a communication partner. Non-Patent Literature 8 does not at all disclose, however, a scheme for precoding in an environment in which feedback information cannot be acquired from the communication partner, such as in the above broadcast or multicast communication.
On the other hand, Non-Patent Literature 4 discloses a scheme for hopping the precoding matrix over time. This scheme can be applied even when no feedback information is available. Non-Patent Literature 4 discloses using a unitary matrix as the matrix for precoding and hopping the unitary matrix at random but does not at all disclose a scheme applicable to degradation of reception quality in the above-described LOS environment. Non-Patent Literature 4 simply recites hopping between precoding matrices at random. Obviously, Non-Patent Literature 4 makes no mention whatsoever of a precoding scheme, or a structure of a precoding matrix, for remedying degradation of reception quality in an LOS environment.
It is an object of the present invention to provide a MIMO system that improves reception quality in an LOS environment.
To solve the above problem, the present invention provides a precoding method for generating, from a plurality of signals which are based on a selected modulation scheme and represented by in-phase components and quadrature components, a plurality of precoded signals that are transmitted in the same frequency bandwidth at the same time and transmitting the generated precoded signals, the precoding method comprising: selecting one precoding weight matrix from among a plurality of precoding weight matrices by regularly hopping between the matrices; and generating the plurality of precoded signals by multiplying the selected precoding weight matrix by the plurality of signals which are based on the selected modulation scheme, the plurality of precoding weight matrices being nine matrices expressed, using a positive real number a, as Equations 339 through 347 (details are described below).
According to each aspect of the above invention, precoded signals, which are generated by precoding signals by using one precoding weight matrix selected from among a plurality of precoding weight matrices by regularly hopping between the matrices, are transmitted and received. Thus the precoding weight matrix used in the precoding is any of a plurality of precoding weight matrices that have been predetermined. This makes it possible to improve the reception quality in an LOS environment based on the design of the plurality of precoding weight matrices.
With the above structure, the present invention provides a precoding method, a precoding device, a transmission method, a reception method, a transmission device, and a reception device that remedy degradation of reception quality in an LOS environment, thereby providing high-quality service to LOS users during broadcast or multicast communication.
The following describes embodiments of the present invention with reference to the drawings.
The following describes the transmission scheme, transmission device, reception scheme, and reception device of the present embodiment.
Prior to describing the present embodiment, an overview is provided of a transmission scheme and decoding scheme in a conventional spatial multiplexing MIMO system.
In this Equation, HNtNr is the channel matrix, n=(n1, . . . , nNr)T is the noise vector, and ni is the i.i.d. complex Gaussian random noise with an average value 0 and variance σ2. From the relationship between transmission symbols and reception symbols that is induced at the reception device, the probability for the received vector may be provided as a multi-dimensional Gaussian distribution, as in Equation 2.
Here, a reception device that performs iterative decoding composed of an outer soft-in/soft-out decoder and a MIMO detector, as in
<Iterative Detection Scheme>
The following describes iterative detection of MIMO signals in the Nt×Nr spatial multiplexing MIMO system.
The log-likelihood ratio of umn is defined as in Equation 6.
From Bayes' theorem, Equation 6 can be expressed as Equation 7.
Let Umn,±1={u|umn=±1}. When approximating ln Σaj˜max ln aj, an approximation of Equation 7 can be sought as Equation 8. Note that the above symbol “˜” indicates approximation.
P(u|umn) and ln P(u|umn) in Equation 8 are represented as follows.
Incidentally, the logarithmic probability of the equation defined in Equation 2 is represented in Equation 12.
Accordingly, from Equations 7 and 13, in MAP or A Posteriori Probability (APP), the a posteriori L-value is represented as follows.
Hereinafter, this is referred to as iterative APP decoding. From Equations 8 and 12, in the log-likelihood ratio utilizing Max-Log approximation (Max-Log APP), the a posteriori L-value is represented as follows.
Hereinafter, this is referred to as iterative Max-log APP decoding. The extrinsic information required in an iterative decoding system can be sought by subtracting prior inputs from Equations 13 and 14.
<System Model>
The reception device performs iterative detection on the above MIMO signals (iterative APP (or iterative Max-log APP) decoding). Decoding of LDPC codes is performed by, for example, sum-product decoding.
Math 16
(ia,ja)=πa(Ωia,jaa) Equation 16
Math 17
(ib,jb)=πb(Ωib,jba) Equation 17
In this case, ia, ib indicate the order of symbols after interleaving, ja, jb indicate the bit positions (ja, jb=1, . . . , h) in the modulation scheme, πa, πb indicate the interleavers for the streams A and B, and Ωia,jaa, Ωib,jbb indicate the order of data in streams A and B before interleaving. Note that
<Iterative Decoding>
The following is a detailed description of the algorithms for sum-product decoding used in decoding of LDPC codes and for iterative detection of MIMO signals in the reception device.
Sum-Product Decoding
Let a two-dimensional M×N matrix H={Hmn} be the check matrix for LDPC codes that are targeted for decoding. Subsets A(m), B(n) of the set [1, N]={1, 2, . . . , N} are defined by the following Equations.
Math 18
A(m)≡{n:Hmn=1} Equation 18
Math 19
B(n)≡{m:Hmn=1} Equation 19
In these Equations, A(m) represents the set of column indices of 1's in the mth column of the check matrix H, and B(n) represents the set of row indices of 1's in the nth row of the check matrix H. The algorithm for sum-product decoding is as follows.
Step A·1 (initialization): let a priori value log-likelihood ratio βmn=0 for all combinations (m, n) satisfying Hmn=1. Assume that the loop variable (the number of iterations) lsum=1 and the maximum number of loops is set to lsum,max.
Step A·2 (row processing): the extrinsic value log-likelihood ratio αmn is updated for all combinations (m, n) satisfying Hmn=1 in the order of m=1, 2, . . . , M, using the following updating Equations.
In these Equations, f represents a Gallager function. Furthermore, the scheme of seeking λn is described in detail later.
Step A·3 (column processing): the extrinsic value log-likelihood ratio βmn is updated for all combinations (m, n) satisfying Hmn=1 in the order of n=1, 2, . . . , N, using the following updating Equation.
Step A·4 (calculating a log-likelihood ratio): the log-likelihood ratio Ln is sought for n∈[1, N] by the following Equation.
Step A·5 (count of the number of iterations): if lsum<lsum,max, then lsum is incremented, and processing returns to step A·2. If lsum=lsum, max, the sum-product decoding in this round is finished.
The operations in one sum-product decoding have been described. Subsequently, iterative MIMO signal detection is performed. In the variables m, n, αmn, βmn, λn, and Ln, used in the above description of the operations of sum-product decoding, the variables in stream A are ma, na, αamana, βamana, λna, and Lna, and the variables in stream B are mb,nb, αbmbnb, βbmbnb, λnb, and Lnb.
<Iterative MIMO Signal Detection>
The following describes the scheme of seeking λn in iterative MIMO signal detection in detail.
The following Equation holds from Equation 1.
The following Equations are defined from the frame structures of
Math 26
na=Ωia,jaa Equation 26
Math 27
nb=Ωib,jbb Equation 27
In this case, na,nb ∈[1, N]. Hereinafter, λna, Lna, λnb, and Lnb, where the number of iterations of iterative MIMO signal detection is k, are represented as λk, na, Lk, na, λk, nb, and Lk, nb.
Step B·1 (initial detection; k=0): λ0, na and λ0, nb are sought as follows in the case of initial detection.
In iterative APP decoding:
In iterative Max-log APP decoding:
Here, let X=a, b. Then, assume that the number of iterations of iterative MIMO signal detection is lmimo=0 and the maximum number of iterations is set to lmimo, max.
Step B·2 (iterative detection; the number of iterations k): λk, na and λk, nb, where the number of iterations is k, are represented as in Equations 31-34, from Equations 11, 13-15, 16, and 17. Let (X, Y)=(a, b)(b, a).
In iterative APP decoding:
In iterative Max-log APP decoding:
Step B·3 (counting the number of iterations and estimating a codeword): increment lmimo if lmimo<lmimo, max, and return to step B·2. Assuming that lmimo=lmimo, max, the estimated codeword is sought as in the following Equation.
Here, let X=a, b.
An interleaver 304A receives the encoded data 303A and the frame structure signal 313 as inputs and performs interleaving, i.e. changing the order of the data, to output interleaved data 305A. (The scheme of interleaving may be hopped based on the frame structure signal 313.) A mapping unit 306A receives the interleaved data 305A and the frame structure signal 313 as inputs, performs modulation such as Quadrature Phase Shift Keying (QPSK), 16 Quadrature Amplitude Modulation (16QAM), 64 Quadrature Amplitude Modulation (64QAM), or the like, and outputs a resulting baseband signal 307A. (The modulation scheme may be hopped based on the frame structure signal 313.)
An encoder 302B receives information (data) 301B and the frame structure signal 313 as inputs and, in accordance with the frame structure signal 313, performs error correction coding such as convolutional coding, LDPC coding, turbo coding, or the like, outputting encoded data 303B. (The frame structure signal 313 includes information such as the error correction scheme used, the coding rate, the block length, and the like. The error correction scheme indicated by the frame structure signal 313 is used. Furthermore, the error correction scheme may be hopped.)
An interleaver 304B receives the encoded data 303B and the frame structure signal 313 as inputs and performs interleaving, i.e. changing the order of the data, to output interleaved data 305B. (The scheme of interleaving may be hopped based on the frame structure signal 313.)
A mapping unit 306B receives the interleaved data 305B and the frame structure signal 313 as inputs, performs modulation such as Quadrature Phase Shift Keying (QPSK), 16 Quadrature Amplitude Modulation (16QAM), 64 Quadrature Amplitude Modulation (64QAM), or the like, and outputs a resulting baseband signal 307B. (The modulation scheme may be hopped based on the frame structure signal 313.)
A weighting information generating unit 314 receives the frame structure signal 313 as an input and outputs information 315 regarding a weighting scheme based on the frame structure signal 313. The weighting scheme is characterized by regular hopping between weights.
A weighting unit 308A receives the baseband signal 307A, the baseband signal 307B, and the information 315 regarding the weighting scheme, and based on the information 315 regarding the weighting scheme, performs weighting on the baseband signal 307A and the baseband signal 307B and outputs a signal 309A resulting from the weighting. Details on the weighting scheme are provided later.
A wireless unit 310A receives the signal 309A resulting from the weighting as an input and performs processing such as orthogonal modulation, band limiting, frequency conversion, amplification, and the like, outputting a transmission signal 311A. A transmission signal 511A is output as a radio wave from an antenna 312A.
A weighting unit 308B receives the baseband signal 307A, the baseband signal 307B, and the information 315 regarding the weighting scheme, and based on the information 315 regarding the weighting scheme, performs weighting on the baseband signal 307A and the baseband signal 307B and outputs a signal 309B resulting from the weighting.
Details on the weighting scheme are provided later.
A wireless unit 310B receives the signal 309B resulting from the weighting as an input and performs processing such as orthogonal modulation, band limiting, frequency conversion, amplification, and the like, outputting a transmission signal 311B. A transmission signal 511B is output as a radio wave from an antenna 312B.
An encoder 402 receives information (data) 401 and the frame structure signal 313 as inputs and, in accordance with the frame structure signal 313, performs error correction coding and outputs encoded data 402.
A distribution unit 404 receives the encoded data 403 as an input, distributes the data 403, and outputs data 405A and data 405B. Note that in
The symbol 501_1 is for estimating channel fluctuation for the modulated signal z1(t) (where t is time) transmitted by the transmission device. The symbol 502_1 is the data symbol transmitted as symbol number u (in the time domain) by the modulated signal z1(t), and the symbol 503_1 is the data symbol transmitted as symbol number u+1 by the modulated signal z1(t).
The symbol 501_2 is for estimating channel fluctuation for the modulated signal z2(t) (where t is time) transmitted by the transmission device. The symbol 502_2 is the data symbol transmitted as symbol number u by the modulated signal z2(t), and the symbol 503_2 is the data symbol transmitted as symbol number u+1 by the modulated signal z2(t).
The following describes the relationships between the modulated signals z1(t) and z2(t) transmitted by the transmission device and the received signals r1 (t) and r2(t) received by the reception device.
In
For symbol number 4i (where i is an integer greater than or equal to zero):
Here, j is an imaginary unit.
For symbol number 4i+1:
For symbol number 4i+2:
For symbol number 4i+3:
In this way, the weighting unit in
Incidentally, Non-Patent Literature 4 describes hopping the precoding weights for each slot. This hopping of precoding weights is characterized by being random. On the other hand, in the present embodiment, a certain period (cycle) is provided, and the precoding weights are hopped between regularly. Furthermore, in each 2×2 precoding weight matrix composed of four precoding weights, the absolute value of each of the four precoding weights is equivalent to (1/sqrt(2)), and hopping is regularly performed between precoding weight matrices having this characteristic.
In an LOS environment, if a special precoding matrix is used, reception quality may greatly improve, yet the special precoding matrix differs depending on the conditions of direct waves. In an LOS environment, however, a certain tendency exists, and if precoding matrices are hopped between regularly in accordance with this tendency, the reception quality of data greatly improves. On the other hand, when precoding matrices are hopped between at random, a precoding matrix other than the above-described special precoding matrix may exist, and the possibility of performing precoding only with biased precoding matrices that are not suitable for the LOS environment also exists. Therefore, in an LOS environment, excellent reception quality may not always be obtained. Accordingly, there is a need for a precoding hopping scheme suitable for an LOS environment. The present invention proposes such a precoding scheme.
A channel fluctuation estimating unit 705_1 for the modulated signal z1 transmitted by the transmission device receives the baseband signal 704_X as an input, extracts a reference symbol 501_1 for channel estimation as in
A channel fluctuation estimating unit 705_2 for the modulated signal z2 transmitted by the transmission device receives the baseband signal 704_X as an input, extracts a reference symbol 501_2 for channel estimation as in
A wireless unit 703_Y receives, as input, a received signal 702_Y received by an antenna 701_Y, performs processing such as frequency conversion, quadrature demodulation, and the like, and outputs a baseband signal 704_Y.
A channel fluctuation estimating unit 707_1 for the modulated signal z1 transmitted by the transmission device receives the baseband signal 704_Y as an input, extracts a reference symbol 501_1 for channel estimation as in
A channel fluctuation estimating unit 707_2 for the modulated signal z2 transmitted by the transmission device receives the baseband signal 704_Y as an input, extracts a reference symbol 501_2 for channel estimation as in
A control information decoding unit 709 receives the baseband signal 704_X and the baseband signal 704_Y as inputs, detects the symbol 500_1 that indicates the transmission scheme as in
A signal processing unit 711 receives, as inputs, the baseband signals 704_X and 704_Y, the channel estimation signals 706_1, 706_2, 708_1, and 708_2, and the signal 710 regarding information on the transmission scheme indicated by the transmission device, performs detection and decoding, and outputs received data 712_1 and 712_2.
Next, operations by the signal processing unit 711 in
Math 41
R(t)=H(t)W(t)S(t) Equation 41
In this case, the reception device can apply the decoding scheme in Non-Patent Literature 2 and Non-Patent Literature 3 to the received vector R(t) by considering H(t)W(t) as the channel matrix.
Therefore, a weighting coefficient generating unit 819 in
An INNER MIMO detector 803 receives the signal 820 regarding information on weighting coefficients as input and, using the signal 820, performs the calculation in Equation 41. Iterative detection and decoding is thus performed. The following describes operations thereof.
In the signal processing unit in
In
Subsequent operations are described separately for initial detection and for iterative decoding (iterative detection).
<Initial Detection>
The INNER MIMO detector 803 receives, as inputs, the baseband signal 801X, the channel estimation signal group 802X, the baseband signal 801Y, and the channel estimation signal group 802Y. Here, the modulation scheme for the modulated signal (stream) s1 and the modulated signal (stream) s2 is described as 16QAM.
The INNER MIMO detector 803 first calculates H(t)W(t) from the channel estimation signal group 802X and the channel estimation signal group 802Y to seek candidate signal points corresponding to the baseband signal 801X.
Similarly, H(t)W(t) is calculated from the channel estimation signal group 802X and the channel estimation signal group 802Y, candidate signal points corresponding to the baseband signal 801Y are sought, the squared Euclidian distance for the received signal point (corresponding to the baseband signal 801Y) is sought, and the squared Euclidian distance is divided by the noise variance σ2. Accordingly, EY(b0, b1, b2, b3, b4, b5, b6, b7), i.e. the value of the squared Euclidian distance between a candidate signal point corresponding to (b0, b1, b2, b3, b4, b5, b6, b7) and a received signal point, divided by the noise variance, is sought.
Then EX(b0, b1, b2, b3, b4, b5, b6, b7)+EY(b0, b1, b2, b3, b4, b5, b6, b7)=E(b0, b1, b2, b3, b4, b5, b6, b7) is sought.
The INNER MIMO detector 803 outputs E(b0, b1, b2, b3, b4, b5, b6, b7) as a signal 804.
A log-likelihood calculating unit 805A receives the signal 804 as input, calculates the log likelihood for bits b0, b1, b2, and b3, and outputs a log-likelihood signal 806A. Note that during calculation of the log likelihood, the log likelihood for “1” and the log likelihood for “0” are calculated. The calculation scheme is as shown in Equations 28, 29, and 30. Details can be found in Non-Patent Literature 2 and Non-Patent Literature 3.
Similarly, a log-likelihood calculating unit 805B receives the signal 804 as input, calculates the log likelihood for bits b4, b5, b6, and b7, and outputs a log-likelihood signal 806B.
A deinterleaver (807A) receives the log-likelihood signal 806A as an input, performs deinterleaving corresponding to the interleaver (the interleaver (304A) in
Similarly, a deinterleaver (807B) receives the log-likelihood signal 806B as an input, performs deinterleaving corresponding to the interleaver (the interleaver (304B) in
A log-likelihood ratio calculating unit 809A receives the interleaved log-likelihood signal 808A as an input, calculates the log-likelihood ratio (LLR) of the bits encoded by the encoder 302A in
Similarly, a log-likelihood ratio calculating unit 809B receives the interleaved log-likelihood signal 808B as an input, calculates the log-likelihood ratio (LLR) of the bits encoded by the encoder 302B in
A soft-in/soft-out decoder 811A receives the log-likelihood ratio signal 810A as an input, performs decoding, and outputs a decoded log-likelihood ratio 812A.
Similarly, a soft-in/soft-out decoder 811B receives the log-likelihood ratio signal 810B as an input, performs decoding, and outputs a decoded log-likelihood ratio 812B.
<Iterative Decoding (Iterative Detection), Number of Iterations k>
An interleaver (813A) receives the log-likelihood ratio 812A decoded by the soft-in/soft-out decoder in the (k−1)th iteration as an input, performs interleaving, and outputs an interleaved log-likelihood ratio 814A. The interleaving pattern in the interleaver (813A) is similar to the interleaving pattern in the interleaver (304A) in
An interleaver (813B) receives the log-likelihood ratio 812B decoded by the soft-in/soft-out decoder in the (k−1)th iteration as an input, performs interleaving, and outputs an interleaved log-likelihood ratio 814B. The interleaving pattern in the interleaver (813B) is similar to the interleaving pattern in the interleaver (304B) in
The INNER MIMO detector 803 receives, as inputs, the baseband signal 816X, the transformed channel estimation signal group 817X, the baseband signal 816Y, the transformed channel estimation signal group 817Y, the interleaved log-likelihood ratio 814A, and the interleaved log-likelihood ratio 814B. The reason for using the baseband signal 816X, the transformed channel estimation signal group 817X, the baseband signal 816Y, and the transformed channel estimation signal group 817Y instead of the baseband signal 801X, the channel estimation signal group 802X, the baseband signal 801Y, and the channel estimation signal group 802Y is because a delay occurs due to iterative decoding.
The difference between operations by the INNER MIMO detector 803 for iterative decoding and for initial detection is the use of the interleaved log-likelihood ratio 814A and the interleaved log-likelihood ratio 814B during signal processing. The INNER MIMO detector 803 first seeks E(b0, b1, b2, b3, b4, b5, b6, b7), as during initial detection. Additionally, coefficients corresponding to Equations 11 and 32 are sought from the interleaved log-likelihood ratio 814A and the interleaved log-likelihood ratio 914B. The value E(b0, b1, b2, b3, b4, b5, b6, b7) is adjusted using the sought coefficients, and the resulting value E′(b0, b1, b2, b3, b4, b5, b6, b7) is output as the signal 804.
The log-likelihood calculating unit 805A receives the signal 804 as input, calculates the log likelihood for bits b0, b1, b2, and b3, and outputs the log-likelihood signal 806A. Note that during calculation of the log likelihood, the log likelihood for “1” and the log likelihood for “0” are calculated. The calculation scheme is as shown in Equations 31, 32, 33, 34, and 35. Details can be found in Non-Patent Literature 2 and Non-Patent Literature 3.
Similarly, the log-likelihood calculating unit 805B receives the signal 804 as input, calculates the log likelihood for bits b4, b5, b6, and b7, and outputs the log-likelihood signal 806B. Operations by the deinterleaver onwards are similar to initial detection.
Note that while
The main part of the present embodiment is calculation of H(t)W(t). Note that as shown in Non-Patent Literature 5 and the like, QR decomposition may be used to perform initial detection and iterative detection.
Furthermore, as shown in Non-Patent Literature 11, based on H(t)W(t), linear operation of the Minimum Mean Squared Error (MMSE) and Zero Forcing (ZF) may be performed in order to perform initial detection.
As described above, when a transmission device transmits a plurality of modulated signals from a plurality of antennas in a MIMO system, the advantageous effect of improved transmission quality, as compared to conventional spatial multiplexing MIMO system, is achieved in an LOS environment in which direct waves dominate by hopping between precoding weights regularly over time, as in the present embodiment.
In the present embodiment, and in particular with regards to the structure of the reception device, operations have been described for a limited number of antennas, but the present invention may be embodied in the same way even if the number of antennas increases. In other words, the number of antennas in the reception device does not affect the operations or advantageous effects of the present embodiment. Furthermore, in the present embodiment, the example of LDPC coding has particularly been explained, but the present invention is not limited to LDPC coding. Furthermore, with regards to the decoding scheme, the soft-in/soft-out decoders are not limited to the example of sum-product decoding. Another soft-in/soft-out decoding scheme may be used, such as a BCJR algorithm, a SOVA algorithm, a Max-log-MAP algorithm, and the like. Details are provided in Non-Patent Literature 6.
Additionally, in the present embodiment, the example of a single carrier scheme has been described, but the present invention is not limited in this way and may be similarly embodied for multi-carrier transmission. Accordingly, when using a scheme such as spread spectrum communication, Orthogonal Frequency-Division Multiplexing (OFDM), Single Carrier Frequency Division Multiple Access (SC-FDMA), Single Carrier Orthogonal Frequency-Division Multiplexing (SC-OFDM), or wavelet OFDM as described in Non-Patent Literature 7 and the like, for example, the present invention may be similarly embodied. Furthermore, in the present embodiment, symbols other than data symbols, such as pilot symbols (preamble, unique word, and the like), symbols for transmission of control information, and the like, may be arranged in the frame in any way.
The following describes an example of using OFDM as an example of a multi-carrier scheme.
An OFDM related processor 1301A receives, as input, the weighted signal 309A, performs processing related to OFDM, and outputs a transmission signal 1302A. Similarly, an OFDM related processor 1301B receives, as input, the weighted signal 309B, performs processing related to OFDM, and outputs a transmission signal 1302B.
A serial/parallel converter 1402A performs serial/parallel conversion on a weighted signal 1401A (corresponding to the weighted signal 309A in
A reordering unit 1404A receives a parallel signal 1403A as input, performs reordering, and outputs a reordered signal 1405A. Reordering is described in detail later.
An inverse fast Fourier transformer 1406A receives the reordered signal 1405A as an input, performs a fast Fourier transform, and outputs a fast Fourier transformed signal 1407A.
A wireless unit 1408A receives the fast Fourier transformed signal 1407A as an input, performs processing such as frequency conversion, amplification, and the like, and outputs a modulated signal 1409A. The modulated signal 1409A is output as a radio wave from an antenna 1410A.
A serial/parallel converter 1402B performs serial/parallel conversion on a weighted signal 1401B (corresponding to the weighted signal 309B in
A reordering unit 1404B receives a parallel signal 1403B as input, performs reordering, and outputs a reordered signal 1405B. Reordering is described in detail later.
An inverse fast Fourier transformer 1406B receives the reordered signal 1405B as an input, performs a fast Fourier transform, and outputs a fast Fourier transformed signal 1407B.
A wireless unit 1408B receives the fast Fourier transformed signal 1407B as an input, performs processing such as frequency conversion, amplification, and the like, and outputs a modulated signal 1409B. The modulated signal 1409B is output as a radio wave from an antenna 1410B.
In the transmission device of
Similarly, numbers #1, #2, #3, #4, . . . are assigned in order to the symbols of the weighted signal 1401B which is input into the serial/parallel converter 1402B. At this point, symbols are assigned regularly, as shown in
The symbol group 1501 and the symbol group 1502 shown in
In this way, when using a multi-carrier transmission scheme such as OFDM, unlike during single carrier transmission, symbols can be arranged in the frequency domain. Furthermore, the ordering of symbols is not limited to the ordering shown in
In
Note that in
In this case, symbol #0 is precoded using the precoding matrix in Equation 37, symbol #1 is precoded using the precoding matrix in Equation 38, symbol #2 is precoded using the precoding matrix in Equation 39, and symbol #3 is precoded using the precoding matrix in Equation 40.
Similarly, for the symbol group 2720 in the frequency domain, symbol #4 is precoded using the precoding matrix in Equation 37, symbol #5 is precoded using the precoding matrix in Equation 38, symbol #6 is precoded using the precoding matrix in Equation 39, and symbol #7 is precoded using the precoding matrix in Equation 40.
For the symbols at time $1, precoding hops between the above precoding matrices, but in the time domain, symbols are cyclically shifted. Therefore, precoding hops between precoding matrices for the symbol groups 2701, 2702, 2703, and 2704 as follows.
In the symbol group 2701 in the time domain, symbol #0 is precoded using the precoding matrix in Equation 37, symbol #9 is precoded using the precoding matrix in Equation 38, symbol #18 is precoded using the precoding matrix in Equation 39, and symbol #27 is precoded using the precoding matrix in Equation 40.
In the symbol group 2702 in the time domain, symbol #28 is precoded using the precoding matrix in Equation 37, symbol #1 is precoded using the precoding matrix in Equation 38, symbol #10 is precoded using the precoding matrix in Equation 39, and symbol #19 is precoded using the precoding matrix in Equation 40.
In the symbol group 2703 in the time domain, symbol #20 is precoded using the precoding matrix in Equation 37, symbol #29 is precoded using the precoding matrix in Equation 38, symbol #2 is precoded using the precoding matrix in Equation 39, and symbol #11 is precoded using the precoding matrix in Equation 40.
In the symbol group 2704 in the time domain, symbol #12 is precoded using the precoding matrix in Equation 37, symbol #21 is precoded using the precoding matrix in Equation 38, symbol #30 is precoded using the precoding matrix in Equation 39, and symbol #3 is precoded using the precoding matrix in Equation 40.
The characteristic of
In
In Embodiment 1, regular hopping of the precoding weights as shown in
In
For symbol number 4i (where i is an integer greater than or equal to zero):
Here, j is an imaginary unit.
For symbol number 4i+1:
For symbol number 4i+2:
For symbol number 4i+3:
From Equations 36 and 41, the received vector R(t)=(r1(t), r2(t))T can be represented as follows.
For symbol number 4i:
For symbol number 4i+1:
For symbol number 4i+2:
For symbol number 4i+3:
In this case, it is assumed that only components of direct waves exist in the channel elements h11(t), h12(t), h21(t), and h22(t), that the amplitude components of the direct waves are all equal, and that fluctuations do not occur over time. With these assumptions, Equations 46-49 can be represented as follows.
For symbol number 4i:
For symbol number 4i+1:
For symbol number 4i+2:
For symbol number 4i+3:
In Equations 50-53, let A be a positive real number and q be a complex number. The values of A and q are determined in accordance with the positional relationship between the transmission device and the reception device. Equations 50-53 can be represented as follows.
For symbol number 4i:
For symbol number 4i+1:
For symbol number 4i+2:
For symbol number 4i+3:
As a result, when q is represented as follows, a signal component based on one of s1 and s2 is no longer included in r1 and r2, and therefore one of the signals s1 and s2 can no longer be obtained.
For symbol number 4i:
Math 58
q=−Aej(θ11(4i)−θ21(4i)),−Aej(θ11(4i)−θ21(4i)−δ) Equation 58
For symbol number 4i+1:
Math 59
q=−Aej(θ
For symbol number 4i+2:
Math 60
q=−Aej(θ
For symbol number 4i+3:
Math 61
q=−Aej(θ
In this case, if q has the same solution in symbol numbers 4i, 4i+1, 4i+2, and 4i+3, then the channel elements of the direct waves do not greatly fluctuate. Therefore, a reception device having channel elements in which the value of q is equivalent to the same solution can no longer obtain excellent reception quality for any of the symbol numbers. Therefore, it is difficult to achieve the ability to correct errors, even if error correction codes are introduced. Accordingly, for q not to have the same solution, the following condition is necessary from Equations 58-61 when focusing on one of two solutions of q which does not include δ.
Math 62
ej(θ
(x is 0, 1, 2, 3; y is 0, 1, 2, 3; and x≠y.)
In an example fulfilling Condition #1, values are set as follows:
(1) θ11(4i)=θ11(4i+1)=θ11(4i+2)=θ11(4i+3)=0 radians,
(2) θ21(4i)=0 radians,
(3) θ21(4i+1)=π/2 radians,
(4) θ21(4i+2)=π radians, and
(5) θ21(4i+3)=3π/2 radians.
(The above is an example. It suffices for one each of zero radians, π/2 radians, π radians, and 3π/2 radians to exist for the set (θ21(4i), θ21(4i+1), θ21(4i+2), θ21(4i+3)).) In this case, in particular under condition (1), there is no need to perform signal processing (rotation processing) on the baseband signal S1(t), which therefore offers the advantage of a reduction in circuit size. Another example is to set values as follows.
(6) θ11(4i)=0 radians,
(7) θ11(4i+1)=π/2 radians,
(8) θ11(4i+2)=π radians,
(9) θ11(4i+3)=3π/2 radians, and
(10) θ21(4i)=θ21(4i+1)=θ21(4i+2)=θ21(4i+3)=0 radians.
(The above is an example. It suffices for one each of zero radians, π/2 radians, π radians, and 3π/2 radians to exist for the set (θ11(4i), θ11(4i+1), θ11(4i+2), θ11(4i+3)).) In this case, in particular under condition (6), there is no need to perform signal processing (rotation processing) on the baseband signal S2(t), which therefore offers the advantage of a reduction in circuit size. Yet another example is as follows.
(11) θ11(4i)=θ11(4i+1)=θ11(4i+2)=θ11(4i+3)=0 radians,
(12) θ21(4i)=0 radians,
(13) θ21(4i+1)=π/4 radians,
(14) θ21(4i+2)=π/2 radians, and
(15) θ21(4i+3)=3π/4 radians.
(The above is an example. It suffices for one each of zero radians, π/4 radians, π/2 radians, and 3π/4 radians to exist for the set (θ21(4i), θ21(4i+1), θ21(4i+2), θ21(4i+3)).)
(16) θ11(4i)=0 radians,
(17) θ11(4i+1)=π/4 radians,
(18) θ11(4i+2)=π/2 radians,
(19) θ11(4i+3)=3π/4 radians, and
(20) θ21(4i)=θ21(4i+1)=θ21(4i+2)=θ21(4i+3)=0 radians.
(The above is an example. It suffices for one each of zero radians, π/4 radians, π/2 radians, and 3π/4 radians to exist for the set (θ11(4i), θ11(4i+1), θ11(4i+2), θ11(4i+3)).)
While four examples have been shown, the scheme of satisfying Condition #1 is not limited to these examples.
Next, design requirements for not only θ11 and θ12, but also for λ and δ are described. It suffices to set λ to a certain value; it is then necessary to establish requirements for δ. The following describes the design scheme for δ when λ is set to zero radians.
In this case, by defining δ so that π/2 radians ≤|δ|≤π radians, excellent reception quality is achieved, particularly in an LOS environment.
Incidentally, for each of the symbol numbers 4i, 4i+1, 4i+2, and 4i+3, two points q exist where reception quality becomes poor. Therefore, a total of 2×4=8 such points exist. In an LOS environment, in order to prevent reception quality from degrading in a specific reception terminal, these eight points should each have a different solution. In this case, in addition to Condition #1, Condition #2 is necessary.
Math 63
ej(θ
and
ej(θ
Additionally, the phase of these eight points should be evenly distributed (since the phase of a direct wave is considered to have a high probability of even distribution). The following describes the design scheme for δ to satisfy this requirement.
In the case of example #1 and example #2, the phase becomes even at the points at which reception quality is poor by setting δ to ±3π/4 radians. For example, letting δ be 3π/4 radians in example #1 (and letting A be a positive real number), then each of the four slots, points at which reception quality becomes poor exist once, as shown in
With the above structure, excellent reception quality is achieved in an LOS environment. Above, an example of changing precoding weights in a four-slot period (cycle) is described, but below, changing precoding weights in an N-slot period (cycle) is described. Making the same considerations as in Embodiment 1 and in the above description, processing represented as below is performed on each symbol number. For symbol number Ni (where i is an integer greater than or equal to zero):
Here, j is an imaginary unit.
For symbol number Ni+1:
When generalized, this equation is as follows.
For symbol number Ni+k (k=0, 1, . . . , N−1):
Furthermore, for symbol number Ni+N−1:
Accordingly, r1 and r2 are represented as follows.
For symbol number Ni (where i is an integer greater than or equal to zero):
Here, j is an imaginary unit.
For symbol number Ni+1:
When generalized, this equation is as follows.
For symbol number Ni+k (k=0, 1, . . . , N−1):
Furthermore, for symbol number Ni+N−1:
In this case, it is assumed that only components of direct waves exist in the channel elements h11(t), h12(t), h21(t), and h22(t), that the amplitude components of the direct waves are all equal, and that fluctuations do not occur over time. With these assumptions, Equations 66-69 can be represented as follows.
For symbol number Ni (where i is an integer greater than or equal to zero):
Here, j is an imaginary unit.
For symbol number Ni+1:
When generalized, this equation is as follows.
For symbol number Ni+k (k=0, 1, . . . , N−1):
Furthermore, for symbol number Ni+N−1:
In Equations 70-73, let A be a real number and q be a complex number. The values of A and q are determined in accordance with the positional relationship between the transmission device and the reception device. Equations 70-73 can be represented as follows.
For symbol number Ni (where i is an integer greater than or equal to zero):
Here, j is an imaginary unit.
For symbol number Ni+1:
When generalized, this equation is as follows.
For symbol number Ni+k (k=0, 1, . . . , N−1):
Furthermore, for symbol number Ni+N−1:
As a result, when q is represented as follows, a signal component based on one of s1 and s2 is no longer included in r1 and r2, and therefore one of the signals s1 and s2 can no longer be obtained.
For symbol number Ni (where i is an integer greater than or equal to zero):
Math 80
q=−Aej(θ
For symbol number Ni+1:
Math 81
q=−Aej(θ
When generalized, this equation is as follows.
For symbol number Ni+k (k=0, 1, . . . , N−1):
Math 82
q=−Aej(θ
Furthermore, for symbol number Ni+N−1:
Math 83
q=−Aej(θ
In this case, if q has the same solution in symbol numbers Ni through Ni+N−1, then since the channel elements of the direct waves do not greatly fluctuate, a reception device having channel elements in which the value of q is equivalent to this same solution can no longer obtain excellent reception quality for any of the symbol numbers. Therefore, it is difficult to achieve the ability to correct errors, even if error correction codes are introduced. Accordingly, for q not to have the same solution, the following condition is necessary from Equations 78-81 when focusing on one of two solutions of q which does not include δ.
Math 84
ej(θ
(x is 0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1; y is 0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1; and x≠y.)
Next, design requirements for not only θ11 and θ12, but also for λ and δ are described. It suffices to set λ to a certain value; it is then necessary to establish requirements for δ. The following describes the design scheme for δ when λ is set to zero radians.
In this case, similar to the scheme of changing the precoding weights in a four-slot period (cycle), by defining δ so that π/2 radians ≤|δ|≤π radians, excellent reception quality is achieved, particularly in an LOS environment.
In each symbol number Ni through Ni+N−1, two points labeled q exist where reception quality becomes poor, and therefore 2N such points exist. In an LOS environment, in order to achieve excellent characteristics, these 2N points should each have a different solution. In this case, in addition to Condition #3, Condition #4 is necessary.
Math 85
ej(θ
and
ej(θ
Additionally, the phase of these 2N points should be evenly distributed (since the phase of a direct wave at each reception device is considered to have a high probability of even distribution).
As described above, when a transmission device transmits a plurality of modulated signals from a plurality of antennas in a MIMO system, the advantageous effect of improved transmission quality, as compared to conventional spatial multiplexing MIMO system, is achieved in an LOS environment in which direct waves dominate by hopping between precoding weights regularly over time.
In the present embodiment, the structure of the reception device is as described in Embodiment 1, and in particular with regards to the structure of the reception device, operations have been described for a limited number of antennas, but the present invention may be embodied in the same way even if the number of antennas increases. In other words, the number of antennas in the reception device does not affect the operations or advantageous effects of the present embodiment. Furthermore, in the present embodiment, similar to Embodiment 1, the error correction codes are not limited.
In the present embodiment, in contrast with Embodiment 1, the scheme of changing the precoding weights in the time domain has been described. As described in Embodiment 1, however, the present invention may be similarly embodied by changing the precoding weights by using a multi-carrier transmission scheme and arranging symbols in the frequency domain and the frequency-time domain. Furthermore, in the present embodiment, symbols other than data symbols, such as pilot symbols (preamble, unique word, and the like), symbols for control information, and the like, may be arranged in the frame in any way.
In Embodiment 1 and Embodiment 2, the scheme of regularly hopping between precoding weights has been described for the case where the amplitude of each element in the precoding weight matrix is equivalent. In the present embodiment, however, an example that does not satisfy this condition is described.
For the sake of contrast with Embodiment 2, the case of changing precoding weights over an N-slot period (cycle) is described. Making the same considerations as in Embodiment 1 and Embodiment 2, processing represented as below is performed on each symbol number. Let β be a positive real number, and β≠1.
For symbol number Ni (where i is an integer greater than or equal to zero):
Here, j is an imaginary unit.
For symbol number Ni+1:
When generalized, this equation is as follows.
For symbol number Ni+k (k=0, 1, . . . , N−1):
Furthermore, for symbol number Ni+N−1:
Accordingly, r1 and r2 are represented as follows.
For symbol number Ni (where i is an integer greater than or equal to zero):
Here, j is an imaginary unit.
For symbol number Ni+1:
When generalized, this equation is as follows.
For symbol number Ni+k (k=0, 1, . . . , N−1):
When generalized, this equation is as follows.
For symbol number Ni+N−1:
In this case, it is assumed that only components of direct waves exist in the channel elements h11(t), h12(t), h21(t), and h22(t), that the amplitude components of the direct waves are all equal, and that fluctuations do not occur over time. With these assumptions, Equations 86-89 can be represented as follows.
For symbol number Ni (where i is an integer greater than or equal to zero):
Here, j is an imaginary unit.
For symbol number Ni+1:
When generalized, this equation is as follows.
For symbol number Ni+k (k=0, 1, . . . , N−1):
Furthermore, for symbol number Ni+N−1:
In Equations 90-93, let A be a real number and q be a complex number. Equations 90-93 can be represented as follows.
For symbol number Ni (where i is an integer greater than or equal to zero):
Here, j is an imaginary unit.
For symbol number Ni+1:
When generalized, this equation is as follows.
For symbol number Ni+k (k=0, 1, . . . , N−1):
Furthermore, for symbol number Ni+N−1:
As a result, when q is represented as follows, one of the signals s1 and s2 can no longer be obtained.
For symbol number Ni (where i is an integer greater than or equal to zero):
For symbol number Ni+1:
When generalized, this equation is as follows.
For symbol number Ni+k (k=0, 1, . . . , N−1):
Furthermore, for symbol number Ni+N−1:
In this case, if q has the same solution in symbol numbers Ni through Ni+N−1, then since the channel elements of the direct waves do not greatly fluctuate, excellent reception quality can no longer be obtained for any of the symbol numbers. Therefore, it is difficult to achieve the ability to correct errors, even if error correction codes are introduced. Accordingly, for q not to have the same solution, the following condition is necessary from Equations 98-101 when focusing on one of two solutions of q which does not include δ.
Math 106
ej(θ
(x is 0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1; y is 0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1; and x≠y.)
Next, design requirements for not only θ11 and θ12, but also for λ and δ are described. It suffices to set λ to a certain value; it is then necessary to establish requirements for δ. The following describes the design scheme for δ when λ is set to zero radians.
In this case, similar to the scheme of changing the precoding weights in a four-slot period (cycle), by defining δ so that π/2 radians ≤|δ|≤π radians, excellent reception quality is achieved, particularly in an LOS environment.
In each of symbol numbers Ni through Ni+N−1, two points q exist where reception quality becomes poor, and therefore 2N such points exist. In an LOS environment, in order to achieve excellent characteristics, these 2N points should each have a different solution. In this case, in addition to Condition #5, considering that β is a positive real number, and β≠1, Condition #6 is necessary.
Math 107
ej(θ
As described above, when a transmission device transmits a plurality of modulated signals from a plurality of antennas in a MIMO system, the advantageous effect of improved transmission quality, as compared to conventional spatial multiplexing MIMO system, is achieved in an LOS environment in which direct waves dominate by hopping between precoding weights regularly over time.
In the present embodiment, the structure of the reception device is as described in Embodiment 1, and in particular with regards to the structure of the reception device, operations have been described for a limited number of antennas, but the present invention may be embodied in the same way even if the number of antennas increases. In other words, the number of antennas in the reception device does not affect the operations or advantageous effects of the present embodiment. Furthermore, in the present embodiment, similar to Embodiment 1, the error correction codes are not limited.
In the present embodiment, in contrast with Embodiment 1, the scheme of changing the precoding weights in the time domain has been described. As described in Embodiment 1, however, the present invention may be similarly embodied by changing the precoding weights by using a multi-carrier transmission scheme and arranging symbols in the frequency domain and the frequency-time domain. Furthermore, in the present embodiment, symbols other than data symbols, such as pilot symbols (preamble, unique word, and the like), symbols for control information, and the like, may be arranged in the frame in any way.
In Embodiment 3, the scheme of regularly hopping between precoding weights has been described for the example of two types of amplitudes for each element in the precoding weight matrix, 1 and β.
In this case,
is ignored.
Next, the example of changing the value of β by slot is described. For the sake of contrast with Embodiment 3, the case of changing precoding weights over a 2×N-slot period (cycle) is described.
Making the same considerations as in Embodiment 1, Embodiment 2, and Embodiment 3, processing represented as below is performed on symbol numbers. Let β be a positive real number, and β≠1. Furthermore, let α be a positive real number, and α≠β.
For symbol number 2Ni (where i is an integer greater than or equal to zero):
Here, j is an imaginary unit.
For symbol number 2Ni+1:
When generalized, this equation is as follows.
For symbol number 2Ni+k (k=0, 1, . . . , N−1):
Furthermore, for symbol number 2Ni+N−1:
For symbol number 2Ni+N (where i is an integer greater than or equal to zero):
Here, j is an imaginary unit.
For symbol number 2Ni+N+1:
When generalized, this equation is as follows.
For symbol number 2Ni+N+k (k=0, 1, . . . , N−1):
Furthermore, for symbol number 2Ni+2N−1:
Accordingly, r1 and r2 are represented as follows.
For symbol number 2Ni (where i is an integer greater than or equal to zero):
Here, j is an imaginary unit.
For symbol number 2Ni+1:
When generalized, this equation is as follows.
For symbol number 2Ni+k (k=0, 1, . . . , N−1):
Furthermore, for symbol number 2Ni+N−1:
For symbol number 2Ni+N (where i is an integer greater than or equal to zero):
Here, j is an imaginary unit.
For symbol number 2Ni+N+1:
When generalized, this equation is as follows.
For symbol number 2Ni+N+k (k=0, 1, . . . , N−1):
When generalized, this equation is as follows.
For symbol number 2Ni+2N−1:
In this case, it is assumed that only components of direct waves exist in the channel elements h11(t), h12(t), h21(t), and h22(t), that the amplitude components of the direct waves are all equal, and that fluctuations do not occur over time. With these assumptions, Equations 110-117 can be represented as follows.
For symbol number 2Ni (where i is an integer greater than or equal to zero):
Here, j is an imaginary unit.
For symbol number 2Ni+1:
When generalized, this equation is as follows.
For symbol number 2Ni+k (k=0, 1, . . . , N−1):
Furthermore, for symbol number 2Ni+N−1:
For symbol number 2Ni+N (where i is an integer greater than or equal to zero):
Here, j is an imaginary unit.
For symbol number 2Ni+N+1:
When generalized, this equation is as follows.
For symbol number 2Ni+N+k (k=0, 1, . . . , N−1):
Furthermore, for symbol number 2Ni+2N−1:
In Equations 118-125, let A be a real number and q be a complex number. Equations 118-125 can be represented as follows.
For symbol number 2Ni (where i is an integer greater than or equal to zero):
Here, j is an imaginary unit.
For symbol number 2Ni+1:
When generalized, this equation is as follows.
For symbol number 2Ni+k (k=0, 1, . . . , N−1):
Furthermore, for symbol number 2Ni+N−1:
For symbol number 2Ni+N (where i is an integer greater than or equal to zero):
Here, j is an imaginary unit.
For symbol number 2Ni+N+1:
When generalized, this equation is as follows.
For symbol number 2Ni+N+k (k=0, 1, . . . , N−1):
Furthermore, for symbol number 2Ni+2N−1:
As a result, when q is represented as follows, one of the signals s1 and s2 can no longer be obtained.
For symbol number 2Ni (where i is an integer greater than or equal to zero):
For symbol number 2Ni+1:
When generalized, this equation is as follows.
For symbol number 2Ni+k (k=0, 1, . . . , N−1):
Furthermore, for symbol number 2Ni+N−1:
For symbol number 2Ni+N (where i is an integer greater than or equal to zero):
For symbol number 2Ni+N+1:
When generalized, this equation is as follows.
For symbol number 2Ni+N+k (k=0, 1, . . . , N−1):
Furthermore, for symbol number 2Ni+2N−1:
In this case, if q has the same solution in symbol numbers 2Ni through 2Ni+N−1, then since the channel elements of the direct waves do not greatly fluctuate, excellent reception quality can no longer be obtained for any of the symbol numbers. Therefore, it is difficult to achieve the ability to correct errors, even if error correction codes are introduced. Accordingly, for q not to have the same solution, Condition #7 or Condition #8 becomes necessary from Equations 134-141 and from the fact that α≠β when focusing on one of two solutions of q which does not include δ.
Math 149
ej(θ
(x is 0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1; y is 0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1; and x≠y.)
and
ej(θ
(x is 0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1; y is 0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1; and x≠y.)
Math 150
ej(θ
In this case, Condition #8 is similar to the conditions described in Embodiment 1 through Embodiment 3. However, with regards to Condition #7, since α≠β, the solution not including δ among the two solutions of q is a different solution.
Next, design requirements for not only θ11 and θ12, but also for λ and δ are described. It suffices to set λ to a certain value; it is then necessary to establish requirements for δ. The following describes the design scheme for δ when λ is set to zero radians.
In this case, similar to the scheme of changing the precoding weights in a four-slot period (cycle), by defining δ so that π/2 radians ≤|δ|≤π radians, excellent reception quality is achieved, particularly in an LOS environment.
In symbol numbers 2Ni through 2Ni+2N−1, two points q exist where reception quality becomes poor, and therefore 4N such points exist. In an LOS environment, in order to achieve excellent characteristics, these 4N points should each have a different solution. In this case, focusing on amplitude, the following condition is necessary for Condition #7 or Condition #8, since α≠β.
As described above, when a transmission device transmits a plurality of modulated signals from a plurality of antennas in a MIMO system, the advantageous effect of improved transmission quality, as compared to conventional spatial multiplexing MIMO system, is achieved in an LOS environment in which direct waves dominate by hopping between precoding weights regularly over time.
In the present embodiment, the structure of the reception device is as described in Embodiment 1, and in particular with regards to the structure of the reception device, operations have been described for a limited number of antennas, but the present invention may be embodied in the same way even if the number of antennas increases. In other words, the number of antennas in the reception device does not affect the operations or advantageous effects of the present embodiment. Furthermore, in the present embodiment, similar to Embodiment 1, the error correction codes are not limited.
In the present embodiment, in contrast with Embodiment 1, the scheme of changing the precoding weights in the time domain has been described. As described in Embodiment 1, however, the present invention may be similarly embodied by changing the precoding weights by using a multi-carrier transmission scheme and arranging symbols in the frequency domain and the frequency-time domain. Furthermore, in the present embodiment, symbols other than data symbols, such as pilot symbols (preamble, unique word, and the like), symbols for control information, and the like, may be arranged in the frame in any way.
In Embodiment 1 through Embodiment 4, the scheme of regularly hopping between precoding weights has been described. In the present embodiment, a modification of this scheme is described.
In Embodiment 1 through Embodiment 4, the scheme of regularly hopping between precoding weights as in
As in
The parts unique to
The first period (cycle) 2201, the second period (cycle) 2202, the third period (cycle) 2203, . . . are all four-slot period (cycle)s.
A different precoding weight matrix is used in each of the four slots, i.e. W1, W2, W3, and W4 are each used once.
It is not necessary for W1, W2, W3, and W4 to be in the same order in the first period (cycle) 2201, the second period (cycle) 2202, the third period (cycle) 2203, . . . .
In order to implement this scheme, a precoding weight generating unit 2200 receives, as an input, a signal regarding a weighting scheme and outputs information 2210 regarding precoding weights in order for each period (cycle). The weighting unit 600 receives, as inputs, this information, s1(t), and s2(t), performs weighting, and outputs z1(t) and z2(t).
In
A reordering unit 2300 receives, as inputs, the precoded signals 2300A and 2300B, reorders the precoded signals 2300A and 2300B in the order of the first period (cycle) 2201, the second period (cycle) 2202, and the third period (cycle) 2203 in
Note that in the above description, the period (cycle) for hopping between precoding weights has been described as having four slots for the sake of comparison with
Furthermore, in Embodiment 1 through Embodiment 4, and in the above precoding scheme, within the period (cycle), the value of δ and β has been described as being the same for each slot, but the value of δ and β may change in each slot.
As described above, when a transmission device transmits a plurality of modulated signals from a plurality of antennas in a MIMO system, the advantageous effect of improved transmission quality, as compared to conventional spatial multiplexing MIMO system, is achieved in an LOS environment in which direct waves dominate by hopping between precoding weights regularly over time.
In the present embodiment, the structure of the reception device is as described in Embodiment 1, and in particular with regards to the structure of the reception device, operations have been described for a limited number of antennas, but the present invention may be embodied in the same way even if the number of antennas increases. In other words, the number of antennas in the reception device does not affect the operations or advantageous effects of the present embodiment. Furthermore, in the present embodiment, similar to Embodiment 1, the error correction codes are not limited.
In the present embodiment, in contrast with Embodiment 1, the scheme of changing the precoding weights in the time domain has been described. As described in Embodiment 1, however, the present invention may be similarly embodied by changing the precoding weights by using a multi-carrier transmission scheme and arranging symbols in the frequency domain and the frequency-time domain. Furthermore, in the present embodiment, symbols other than data symbols, such as pilot symbols (preamble, unique word, and the like), symbols for control information, and the like, may be arranged in the frame in any way.
In Embodiments 1-4, a scheme for regularly hopping between precoding weights has been described. In the present embodiment, a scheme for regularly hopping between precoding weights is again described, including the content that has been described in Embodiments 1-4.
First, out of consideration of an LOS environment, a scheme of designing a precoding matrix is described for a 2×2 spatial multiplexing MIMO system that adopts precoding in which feedback from a communication partner is not available.
Accordingly, letting a received vector be y(p)=(y1(p), y2(p))T, the received vector y(p) is represented by the following equation.
In this Equation, H(p) is the channel matrix, n(p)=(n1(p), n2(p))T is the noise vector, and ni(p) is the i.i.d. complex Gaussian random noise with an average value 0 and variance σ2. Letting the Rician factor be K, the above equation can be represented as follows.
In this equation, Hd(p) is the channel matrix for the direct wave components, and Hs(p) is the channel matrix for the scattered wave components. Accordingly, the channel matrix H(p) is represented as follows.
In Equation 145, it is assumed that the direct wave environment is uniquely determined by the positional relationship between transmitters, and that the channel matrix Hd(p) for the direct wave components does not fluctuate with time. Furthermore, in the channel matrix Hd(p) for the direct wave components, it is assumed that as compared to the interval between transmitting antennas, the probability of an environment with a sufficiently long distance between transmission and reception devices is high, and therefore that the channel matrix for the direct wave components can be treated as a non-singular matrix. Accordingly, the channel matrix Hd(p) is represented as follows.
In this equation, let A be a positive real number and q be a complex number. Subsequently, out of consideration of an LOS environment, a scheme of designing a precoding matrix is described for a 2×2 spatial multiplexing MIMO system that adopts precoding in which feedback from a communication partner is not available.
From Equations 144 and 145, it is difficult to seek a precoding matrix without appropriate feedback in conditions including scattered waves, since it is difficult to perform analysis under conditions including scattered waves. Additionally, in a NLOS environment, little degradation in reception quality of data occurs as compared to an LOS environment. Therefore, the following describes a scheme of designing precoding matrices without appropriate feedback in an LOS environment (precoding matrices for a precoding scheme that hops between precoding matrices over time).
As described above, since it is difficult to perform analysis under conditions including scattered waves, an appropriate precoding matrix for a channel matrix including components of only direct waves is sought from Equations 144 and 145. Therefore, in Equation 144, the case when the channel matrix includes components of only direct waves is considered. It follows that from Equation 146, Equation 144 can be represented as follows.
In this equation, a unitary matrix is used as the precoding matrix. Accordingly, the precoding matrix is represented as follows.
In this equation, λ is a fixed value. Therefore, Equation 147 can be represented as follows.
As is clear from Equation 149, when the reception device performs linear operation of Zero Forcing (ZF) or the Minimum Mean Squared Error (MMSE), the transmitted bit cannot be determined by s1(p), s2(p). Therefore, the iterative APP (or iterative Max-log APP) or APP (or Max-log APP) described in Embodiment 1 is performed (hereafter referred to as Maximum Likelihood (ML) calculation), the log-likelihood ratio of each bit transmitted in s1(p), s2(p) is sought, and decoding with error correction codes is performed. Accordingly, the following describes a scheme of designing a precoding matrix without appropriate feedback in an LOS environment for a reception device that performs ML calculation.
The precoding in Equation 149 is considered. The right-hand side and left-hand side of the first line are multiplied by e−jΨ, and similarly the right-hand side and left-hand side of the second line are multiplied by e−jΨ. The following equation represents the result.
e−jΨy1(p), e−jΨy2(p), and e−jΨq are respectively redefined as y1(p), y2(p), and q. Furthermore, since e−jΨn(p)=(e−jΨn1(p), e−jΨn2(p))T, and e−jΨn1(p), e−jΨn2(p) are the independent identically distributed (i.i.d.) complex Gaussian random noise with an average value 0 and variance σ2, e−jΨn(p) is redefined as n(p). As a result, generality is not lost by restating Equation 150 as Equation 151.
Next, Equation 151 is transformed into Equation 152 for the sake of clarity.
In this case, letting the minimum Euclidian distance between a received signal point and a received candidate signal point be dmin2, then a poor point has a minimum value of zero for dmin2, and two values of q exist at which conditions are poor in that all of the bits transmitted by s1(p) and all of the bits transmitted by s2(p) being eliminated.
In Equation 152, when s1(p) does not exist.
In Equation 152, when s2(p) does not exist.
Math 164
q=−Aαej(θ
(Hereinafter, the values of q satisfying Equations 153 and 154 are respectively referred to as “poor reception points for s1 and s2”).
When Equation 153 is satisfied, since all of the bits transmitted by s1(p) are eliminated, the received log-likelihood ratio cannot be sought for any of the bits transmitted by s1(p). When Equation 154 is satisfied, since all of the bits transmitted by s2(p) are eliminated, the received log-likelihood ratio cannot be sought for any of the bits transmitted by s2(p).
A broadcast/multicast transmission system that does not change the precoding matrix is now considered. In this case, a system model is considered in which a base station transmits modulated signals using a precoding scheme that does not hop between precoding matrices, and a plurality of terminals (Γ terminals) receive the modulated signals transmitted by the base station.
It is considered that the conditions of direct waves between the base station and the terminals change little over time. Therefore, from Equations 153 and 154, for a terminal that is in a position fitting the conditions of Equation 155 or Equation 156 and that is in an LOS environment where the Rician factor is large, the possibility of degradation in the reception quality of data exists. Accordingly, to resolve this problem, it is necessary to change the precoding matrix over time.
A scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices over a time period (cycle) with N slots (hereinafter referred to as a precoding hopping scheme) is considered.
Since there are N slots in the time period (cycle), N varieties of precoding matrices F[i] based on Equation 148 are prepared (i=0, 1, . . . , N−1). In this case, the precoding matrices F[i] are represented as follows.
In this equation, let α not change over time, and let λ also not change over time (though change over time may be allowed).
As in Embodiment 1, F[i] is the precoding matrix used to obtain a precoded signal x (p=N×k+i) in Equation 142 for time N×k+i (where k is an integer equal to or greater than 0, and i=0, 1, . . . , N−1). The same is true below as well.
At this point, based on Equations 153 and 154, design conditions such as the following are important for the precoding matrices for precoding hopping.
Math 168
Condition #10
ej(θ
Math 169
Condition #11
ej(θ
From Condition #10, in all of the Γ terminals, there is one slot or less having poor reception points for s1 among the N slots in a time period (cycle). Accordingly, the log-likelihood ratio for bits transmitted by s1 (p) can be obtained for at least N−1 slots. Similarly, from Condition #11, in all of the Γ terminals, there is one slot or less having poor reception points for s2 among the N slots in a time period (cycle). Accordingly, the log-likelihood ratio for bits transmitted by s2(p) can be obtained for at least N−1 slots.
In this way, by providing the precoding matrix design model of Condition #10 and Condition #11, the number of bits for which the log-likelihood ratio is obtained among the bits transmitted by s1 (p), and the number of bits for which the log-likelihood ratio is obtained among the bits transmitted by s2(p) is guaranteed to be equal to or greater than a fixed number in all of the Γ terminals. Therefore, in all of the Γ terminals, it is considered that degradation of data reception quality is moderated in an LOS environment where the Rician factor is large.
The following shows an example of a precoding matrix in the precoding hopping scheme.
The probability density distribution of the phase of a direct wave can be considered to be evenly distributed over [0 2π]. Therefore, the probability density distribution of the phase of q in Equations 151 and 152 can also be considered to be evenly distributed over [0 2π]. Accordingly, the following is established as a condition for providing fair data reception quality insofar as possible for Γ terminals in the same LOS environment in which only the phase of q differs.
Condition #12
When using a precoding hopping scheme with an N-slot time period (cycle), among the N slots in the time period (cycle), the poor reception points for s1 are arranged to have an even distribution in terms of phase, and the poor reception points for s2 are arranged to have an even distribution in terms of phase.
The following describes an example of a precoding matrix in the precoding hopping scheme based on Condition #10 through Condition #12. Let a=1.0 in the precoding matrix in Equation 157.
Let the number of slots N in the time period (cycle) be 8. In order to satisfy Condition #10 through Condition #12, precoding matrices for a precoding hopping scheme with an N=8 time period (cycle) are provided as in the following equation.
Here, j is an imaginary unit, and i=0, 1, . . . , 7. Instead of Equation 160, Equation 161 may be provided (where λ and θ11[i] do not change over time (though change may be allowed)).
Accordingly, the poor reception points for s1 and s2 become as in
Next, the following is established as a condition, different from Condition #12, for providing fair data reception quality insofar as possible for Γ terminals in the same LOS environment in which only the phase of q differs.
Condition #13
When using a precoding hopping scheme with an N-slot time period (cycle), in addition to the condition
Math 174
ej(θ
the poor reception points for s1 and the poor reception points for s2 are arranged to be in an even distribution with respect to phase in the N slots in the time period (cycle).
The following describes an example of a precoding matrix in the precoding hopping scheme based on Condition #10, Condition #11, and Condition #13. Let α=1.0 in the precoding matrix in Equation 157.
Let the number of slots N in the time period (cycle) be 4. Precoding matrices for a precoding hopping scheme with an N=4 time period (cycle) are provided as in the following equation.
Here, j is an imaginary unit, and i=0, 1, 2, 3. Instead of Equation 165, Equation 166 may be provided (where λ and θ11[i] do not change over time (though change may be allowed)).
Accordingly, the poor reception points for s1 and s2 become as in
Next, a precoding hopping scheme using a non-unitary matrix is described.
Based on Equation 148, the precoding matrices presently under consideration are represented as follows.
Equations corresponding to Equations 151 and 152 are represented as follows.
In this case, there are two q at which the minimum value dmin2 of the Euclidian distance between a received signal point and a received candidate signal point is zero.
In Equation 171, when s1 (p) does not exist:
In Equation 171, when s2(p) does not exist:
Math 183
q=−Aαej(θ
In the precoding hopping scheme for an N-slot time period (cycle), by referring to Equation 169, N varieties of the precoding matrix F[i] are represented as follows.
In this equation, let α and δ not change over time. At this point, based on Equations 34 and 35, design conditions such as the following are provided for the precoding matrices for precoding hopping.
Math 185
Condition #14
ej(θ
Math 186
Condition #15
ej(θ
Let α=1.0 in the precoding matrix in Equation 174. Let the number of slots N in the time period (cycle) be 16. In order to satisfy Condition #12, Condition #14, and Condition #15, precoding matrices for a precoding hopping scheme with an N=16 time period (cycle) are provided as in the following equations.
For i=0, 1, . . . , 7:
For i=8, 9, . . . , 15:
Furthermore, a precoding matrix that differs from Equations 177 and 178 can be provided as follows.
For i=0, 1, . . . , 7:
For i=8, 9, . . . , 15:
Accordingly, the poor reception points for s1 and s2 become as in
(In
For i=0, 1, . . . , 7:
For i=8, 9, . . . , 15:
or
For i=0, 1, . . . , 7:
For i=8, 9, . . . , 15:
(In Equations 177-184, 7π/8 may be changed to −7π/8.)
Next, the following is established as a condition, different from Condition #12, for providing fair data reception quality insofar as possible for Γ terminals in the same LOS environment in which only the phase of q differs.
Condition #16
When using a precoding hopping scheme with an N-slot time period (cycle), the following condition is set:
Math 195
ej(θ
and the poor reception points for s1 and the poor reception points for s2 are arranged to be in an even distribution with respect to phase in the N slots in the time period (cycle).
The following describes an example of a precoding matrix in the precoding hopping scheme based on Condition #14, Condition #15, and Condition #16. Let α=1.0 in the precoding matrix in Equation 174.
Let the number of slots N in the time period (cycle) be 8. Precoding matrices for a precoding hopping scheme with an N=8 time period (cycle) are provided as in the following equation.
Here, i=0, 1, . . . , 7.
Furthermore, a precoding matrix that differs from Equation 186 can be provided as follows (where i=0, 1, . . . , 7, and where λ and θ11[i] do not change over time (though change may be allowed)).
Accordingly, the poor reception points for s1 and s2 become as in
(In Equations 186-189, 7π/8 may be changed to −7π/8.)
Next, in the precoding matrix of Equation 174, a precoding hopping scheme that differs from Example #7 and Example #8 by letting α≠1, and by taking into consideration the distance in the complex plane between poor reception points, is examined.
In this case, the precoding hopping scheme for an N-slot time period (cycle) of Equation 174 is used, and from Condition #14, in all of the Γ terminals, there is one slot or less having poor reception points for s1 among the N slots in a time period (cycle). Accordingly, the log-likelihood ratio for bits transmitted by s1(p) can be obtained for at least N−1 slots. Similarly, from Condition #15, in all of the Γ terminals, there is one slot or less having poor reception points for s2 among the N slots in a time period (cycle). Accordingly, the log-likelihood ratio for bits transmitted by s2(p) can be obtained for at least N−1 slots.
Therefore, it is clear that a larger value for N in the N-slot time period (cycle) increases the number of slots in which the log-likelihood ratio can be obtained.
Incidentally, since the influence of scattered wave components is also present in an actual channel model, it is considered that when the number of slots N in the time period (cycle) is fixed, there is a possibility of improved data reception quality if the minimum distance in the complex plane between poor reception points is as large as possible. Accordingly, in the context of Example #7 and Example #8, precoding hopping schemes in which α≠1 and which improve on Example #7 and Example #8 are considered. The precoding scheme that improves on Example #8 is easier to understand and is therefore described first.
From Equation 186, the precoding matrices in an N=8 time period (cycle) precoding hopping scheme that improves on Example #8 are provided in the following equation.
Here, i=0, 1, . . . , 7. Furthermore, precoding matrices that differ from Equation 190 can be provided as follows (where i=0, 1, . . . , 7, and where λ and θ11[i] do not change over time (though change may be allowed)).
Therefore, the poor reception points for s1 and s2 are represented as in
(i) When α<1.0
When α<1.0, the minimum distance in the complex plane between poor reception points is represented as min{d#1,#2, d#1,#3} when focusing on the distance (d#1,#2) between poor reception points #1 and #2 and the distance (d#1,#3) between poor reception points #1 and #3. In this case, the relationship between α and d#1,#2 and between α and d#1,#3 is shown in
The min{d#1,#2, d#1,#3} in this case is as follows.
Therefore, the precoding scheme using the value of α in Equation 198 for Equations 190-197 is effective. Setting the value of α as in Equation 198 is one appropriate scheme for obtaining excellent data reception quality. Setting a to be a value near Equation 198, however, may similarly allow for excellent data reception quality. Accordingly, the value to which α is set is not limited to Equation 198.
(ii) When α>1.0
When α>1.0, the minimum distance in the complex plane between poor reception points is represented as min{d#4,#5, d#4,#6} when focusing on the distance (d#4,#5) between poor reception points #4 and #5 and the distance (d#4,#6) between poor reception points #4 and #6. In this case, the relationship between α and d#4,#5 and between α and d#4,#6 is shown in
The min{d#4,#5, d#4,#6} in this case is as follows.
Therefore, the precoding scheme using the value of α in Equation 200 for Equations 190-197 is effective. Setting the value of α as in Equation 200 is one appropriate scheme for obtaining excellent data reception quality. Setting α to be a value near Equation 200, however, may similarly allow for excellent data reception quality. Accordingly, the value to which α is set is not limited to Equation 200.
Based on consideration of Example #9, the precoding matrices in an N=16 time period (cycle) precoding hopping scheme that improves on Example #7 are provided in the following equations (where λ and θ11[i] do not change over time (though change may be allowed)).
For i=0, 1, . . . , 7:
For i=8, 9, . . . , 15:
or
For i=0, 1, . . . , 7:
For i=8, 9, . . . , 15:
or
For i=0, 1, . . . , 7:
For i=8, 9, . . . , 15:
or
For i=0, 1, . . . , 7:
For i=8, 9, . . . , 15:
or
For i=0, 1, . . . , 7:
For i=8, 9, . . . , 15:
or
For i=0, 1, . . . , 7:
For i=8, 9, . . . , 15:
or
For i=0, 1, . . . , 7:
For i=8, 9, . . . , 15:
or
For i=0, 1, . . . , 7:
For i=8, 9, . . . , 15:
The value of α in Equation 198 and in Equation 200 is appropriate for obtaining excellent data reception quality. The poor reception points for s1 are represented as in
In the present embodiment, the scheme of structuring N different precoding matrices for a precoding hopping scheme with an N-slot time period (cycle) has been described. In this case, as the N different precoding matrices, F[0], F[1], F[2], . . . , F[N−2], F[N−1] are prepared. In the present embodiment, an example of a single carrier transmission scheme has been described, and therefore the case of arranging symbols in the order F[0], F[1], F[2], . . . , F[N−2], F[N−1] in the time domain (or the frequency domain) has been described. The present invention is not, however, limited in this way, and the N different precoding matrices F[0], F[1], F[2], . . . , F[N−2], F[N−1] generated in the present embodiment may be adapted to a multi-carrier transmission scheme such as an OFDM transmission scheme or the like. As in Embodiment 1, as a scheme of adaption in this case, precoding weights may be changed by arranging symbols in the frequency domain and in the frequency-time domain. Note that a precoding hopping scheme with an N-slot time period (cycle) has been described, but the same advantageous effects may be obtained by randomly using N different precoding matrices. In other words, the N different precoding matrices do not necessarily need to be used in a regular period (cycle).
Examples #5 through #10 have been shown based on Conditions #10 through #16. However, in order to achieve a precoding matrix hopping scheme with a longer period (cycle), the period (cycle) for hopping between precoding matrices may be lengthened by, for example, selecting a plurality of examples from Examples #5 through #10 and using the precoding matrices indicated in the selected examples. For example, a precoding matrix hopping scheme with a longer period (cycle) may be achieved by using the precoding matrices indicated in Example #7 and the precoding matrices indicated in Example #10. In this case, Conditions #10 through #16 are not necessarily observed. (In Equation 158 of Condition #10, Equation 159 of Condition #11, Equation 164 of Condition #13, Equation 175 of Condition #14, and Equation 176 of Condition #15, it becomes important for providing excellent reception quality for the conditions “all x and all y” to be “existing x and existing y”.) When viewed from a different perspective, in the precoding matrix hopping scheme over an N-slot period (cycle) (where N is a large natural number), the probability of providing excellent reception quality increases when the precoding matrices of one of Examples #5 through #10 are included.
The present embodiment describes the structure of a reception device for receiving modulated signals transmitted by a transmission scheme that regularly hops between precoding matrices as described in Embodiments 1-6.
In Embodiment 1, the following scheme has been described. A transmission device that transmits modulated signals, using a transmission scheme that regularly hops between precoding matrices, transmits information regarding the precoding matrices. Based on this information, a reception device obtains information on the regular precoding matrix hopping used in the transmitted frames, decodes the precoding, performs detection, obtains the log-likelihood ratio for the transmitted bits, and subsequently performs error correction decoding.
The present embodiment describes the structure of a reception device, and a scheme of hopping between precoding matrices, that differ from the above structure and scheme.
When one encoder operates, the transmission bits (4001) are encoded to yield encoded transmission bits. The encoded transmission bits are allocated into two parts, and the encoder group (4002) outputs allocated bits (4003A) and allocated bits (4003B).
When two encoders operate, the transmission bits (4001) are divided in two (referred to as divided bits A and B). The first encoder receives the divided bits A as input, encodes the divided bits A, and outputs the encoded bits as allocated bits (4003A). The second encoder receives the divided bits B as input, encodes the divided bits B, and outputs the encoded bits as allocated bits (4003B).
When four encoders operate, the transmission bits (4001) are divided in four (referred to as divided bits A, B, C, and D). The first encoder receives the divided bits A as input, encodes the divided bits A, and outputs the encoded bits A. The second encoder receives the divided bits B as input, encodes the divided bits B, and outputs the encoded bits B. The third encoder receives the divided bits C as input, encodes the divided bits C, and outputs the encoded bits C. The fourth encoder receives the divided bits D as input, encodes the divided bits D, and outputs the encoded bits D. The encoded bits A, B, C, and D are divided into allocated bits (4003A) and allocated bits (4003B).
The transmission device supports a transmission scheme such as, for example, the following Table 1 (Table 1A and Table 1B).
As shown in Table 1, transmission of a one-stream signal and transmission of a two-stream signal are supported as the number of transmission signals (number of transmit antennas). Furthermore, QPSK, 16QAM, 64QAM, 256QAM, and 1024QAM are supported as the modulation scheme. In particular, when the number of transmission signals is two, it is possible to set separate modulation schemes for stream #1 and stream #2. For example, “#1: 256QAM, #2: 1024QAM” in Table 1 indicates that “the modulation scheme of stream #1 is 256QAM, and the modulation scheme of stream #2 is 1024QAM” (other entries in the table are similarly expressed). Three types of error correction coding schemes, A, B, and C, are supported. In this case, A, B, and C may all be different coding schemes. A, B, and C may also be different coding rates, and A, B, and C may be coding schemes with different block sizes.
The pieces of transmission information in Table 1 are allocated to modes that define a “number of transmission signals”, “modulation scheme”, “number of encoders”, and “error correction coding scheme”. Accordingly, in the case of “number of transmission signals: 2”, “modulation scheme: #1: 1024QAM, #2: 1024QAM”, “number of encoders: 4”, and “error correction coding scheme: C”, for example, the transmission information is set to 01001101. In the frame, the transmission device transmits the transmission information and the transmission data. When transmitting the transmission data, in particular when the “number of transmission signals” is two, a “precoding matrix hopping scheme” is used in accordance with Table 1. In Table 1, five types of the “precoding matrix hopping scheme”, D, E, F, G, and H, are prepared. The precoding matrix hopping scheme is set to one of these five types in accordance with Table 1. The following, for example, are ways of implementing the five different types.
Prepare five different precoding matrices.
Use five different types of period (cycle)s, for example a four-slot period (cycle) for D, an eight-slot period (cycle) for E, . . . .
Use both different precoding matrices and different period (cycle)s.
In
Furthermore, in
Accordingly, the transmission device in
The structure of the reception device may be represented similarly to
Note that in the above description, “transmission information” is set with respect to the “number of transmission signals”, “modulation scheme”, “number of encoders”, and “error correction coding scheme” as in Table 1, and the precoding matrix hopping scheme is set with respect to the “transmission information”. However, it is not necessary to set the “transmission information” with respect to the “number of transmission signals”, “modulation scheme”, “number of encoders”, and “error correction coding scheme”. For example, as in Table 2, the “transmission information” may be set with respect to the “number of transmission signals” and “modulation scheme”, and the precoding matrix hopping scheme may be set with respect to the “transmission information”.
In this context, the “transmission information” and the scheme of setting the precoding matrix hopping scheme is not limited to Tables 1 and 2. As long as a rule is determined in advance for hopping the precoding matrix hopping scheme based on transmission parameters, such as the “number of transmission signals”, “modulation scheme”, “number of encoders”, “error correction coding scheme”, or the like (as long as the transmission device and the reception device share a predetermined rule, or in other words, if the precoding matrix hopping scheme is hopped based on any of the transmission parameters (or on any plurality of transmission parameters)), the transmission device does not need to transmit information regarding the precoding matrix hopping scheme. The reception device can identify the precoding matrix hopping scheme used by the transmission device by identifying the information on the transmission parameters and can therefore accurately perform decoding and detection. Note that in Tables 1 and 2, a transmission scheme that regularly hops between precoding matrices is used when the number of modulated transmission signals is two, but a transmission scheme that regularly hops between precoding matrices may be used when the number of modulated transmission signals is two or greater.
Accordingly, if the transmission device and reception device share a table regarding transmission patterns that includes information on precoding hopping schemes, the transmission device need not transmit information regarding the precoding hopping scheme, transmitting instead control information that does not include information regarding the precoding hopping scheme, and the reception device can infer the precoding hopping scheme by acquiring this control information.
As described above, in the present embodiment, the transmission device does not transmit information directly related to the scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices. Rather, a scheme has been described wherein the reception device infers information regarding precoding for the “scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices” used by the transmission device. This scheme yields the advantageous effect of improved transmission efficiency of data as a result of the transmission device not transmitting information directly related to the scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices.
Note that the present embodiment has been described as changing precoding weights in the time domain, but as described in Embodiment 1, the present invention may be similarly embodied when using a multi-carrier transmission scheme such as OFDM or the like.
In particular, when the precoding hopping scheme only changes depending on the number of transmission signals, the reception device can learn the precoding hopping scheme by acquiring information, transmitted by the transmission device, on the number of transmission signals.
In the present description, it is considered that a communications/broadcasting device such as a broadcast station, a base station, an access point, a terminal, a mobile phone, or the like is provided with the transmission device, and that a communications device such as a television, radio, terminal, personal computer, mobile phone, access point, base station, or the like is provided with the reception device. Additionally, it is considered that the transmission device and the reception device in the present description have a communications function and are capable of being connected via some sort of interface to a device for executing applications for a television, radio, personal computer, mobile phone, or the like.
Furthermore, in the present embodiment, symbols other than data symbols, such as pilot symbols (preamble, unique word, postamble, reference symbol, and the like), symbols for control information, and the like may be arranged in the frame in any way. While the terms “pilot symbol” and “symbols for control information” have been used here, any term may be used, since the function itself is what is important.
It suffices for a pilot symbol, for example, to be a known symbol modulated with PSK modulation in the transmission and reception devices (or for the reception device to be able to synchronize in order to know the symbol transmitted by the transmission device). The reception device uses this symbol for frequency synchronization, time synchronization, channel estimation (estimation of Channel State Information (CSI) for each modulated signal), detection of signals, and the like.
A symbol for control information is for transmitting information other than data (of applications or the like) that needs to be transmitted to the communication partner for achieving communication (for example, the modulation scheme, error correction coding scheme, coding rate of the error correction coding scheme, setting information in the upper layer, and the like).
Note that the present invention is not limited to the above Embodiments 1-5 and may be embodied with a variety of modifications. For example, the above embodiments describe communications devices, but the present invention is not limited to these devices and may be implemented as software for the corresponding communications scheme.
Furthermore, a precoding hopping scheme used in a scheme of transmitting two modulated signals from two antennas has been described, but the present invention is not limited in this way. The present invention may be also embodied as a precoding hopping scheme for similarly changing precoding weights (matrices) in the context of a scheme whereby four mapped signals are precoded to generate four modulated signals that are transmitted from four antennas, or more generally, whereby N mapped signals are precoded to generate N modulated signals that are transmitted from N antennas.
In the description, terms such as “precoding” and “precoding weight” are used, but any other terms may be used. What matters in the present invention is the actual signal processing.
Different data may be transmitted in streams s1(t) and s2(t), or the same data may be transmitted.
Each of the transmit antennas of the transmission device and the receive antennas of the reception device shown in the figures may be formed by a plurality of antennas.
Programs for executing the above transmission scheme may, for example, be stored in advance in Read Only Memory (ROM) and be caused to operate by a Central Processing Unit (CPU).
Furthermore, the programs for executing the above transmission scheme may be stored in a computer-readable recording medium, the programs stored in the recording medium may be loaded in the Random Access Memory (RAM) of the computer, and the computer may be caused to operate in accordance with the programs.
The components in the above embodiments may be typically assembled as a Large Scale Integration (LSI), a type of integrated circuit. Individual components may respectively be made into discrete chips, or part or all of the components in each embodiment may be made into one chip. While an LSI has been referred to, the terms Integrated Circuit (IC), system LSI, super LSI, or ultra LSI may be used depending on the degree of integration. Furthermore, the scheme for assembling integrated circuits is not limited to LSI, and a dedicated circuit or a general-purpose processor may be used. A Field Programmable Gate Array (FPGA), which is programmable after the LSI is manufactured, or a reconfigurable processor, which allows reconfiguration of the connections and settings of circuit cells inside the LSI, may be used.
Furthermore, if technology for forming integrated circuits that replaces LSIs emerges, owing to advances in semiconductor technology or to another derivative technology, the integration of functional blocks may naturally be accomplished using such technology. The application of biotechnology or the like is possible.
The present embodiment describes an application of the scheme described in Embodiments 1-4 and Embodiment 6 for regularly hopping between precoding weights.
At this point, when for example a precoding matrix hopping scheme with an N=8 period (cycle) as in Example #8 in Embodiment 6 is used, z1(t) and z2(t) are represented as follows.
For symbol number 8i (where i is an integer greater than or equal to zero):
Here, j is an imaginary unit, and k=0.
For symbol number 8i+1:
Here, k=1.
For symbol number 8i+2:
Here, k=2.
For symbol number 8i+3:
Here, k=3.
For symbol number 8i+4:
Here, k=4.
For symbol number 8i+5:
Here, k=5.
For symbol number 8i+6:
Here, k=6.
For symbol number 8i+7:
Here, k=7.
The symbol numbers shown here can be considered to indicate time. As described in other embodiments, in Equation 225, for example, z1(8i+7) and z2(8i+7) at time 8i+7 are signals at the same time, and the transmission device transmits z1(8i+7) and z2(8i+7) over the same (shared/common) frequency. In other words, letting the signals at time T be s1(T), s2(T), z1(T), and z2(T), then z1(T) and z2(T) are sought from some sort of precoding matrices and from s1(T) and s2(T), and the transmission device transmits z1(T) and z2(T) over the same (shared/common) frequency (at the same time). Furthermore, in the case of using a multi-carrier transmission scheme such as OFDM or the like, and letting signals corresponding to s1, s2, z1, and z2 for (sub)carrier L and time T be s1(T, L), s2(T, L), z1(T, L), and z2(T, L), then z1(T, L) and z2(T, L) are sought from some sort of precoding matrices and from s1(T, L) and s2(T, L), and the transmission device transmits z1(T, L) and z2(T, L) over the same (shared/common) frequency (at the same time).
In this case, the appropriate value of α is given by Equation 198 or Equation 200.
The present embodiment describes a precoding hopping scheme that increases period (cycle) size, based on the above-described precoding matrices of Equation 190.
Letting the period (cycle) of the precoding hopping scheme be 8M, 8M different precoding matrices are represented as follows.
In this case, i=0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, and k=0, 1, . . . , M−2, M−1.
For example, letting M=2 and α<1, the poor reception points for s1 (∘) and for s2 (□) at k=0 are represented as in
Here, i=0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, and k=0, 1.
In this case, when M=2, precoding matrices F[0]-F[15] are generated (the precoding matrices F[0]-F[15] may be in any order, and the matrices F[0]-F[15] may each be different). Symbol number 16i may be precoded using F[0], symbol number 16i+1 may be precoded using F[1], . . . , and symbol number 16i+h may be precoded using F[h], for example (h=0, 1, 2, . . . , 14, 15). (In this case, as described in previous embodiments, precoding matrices need not be hopped between regularly.)
Summarizing the above considerations, with reference to Equations 82-85, N-period (cycle) precoding matrices are represented by the following equation.
Here, since the period (cycle) has N slots, i=0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1. Furthermore, the N×M period (cycle) precoding matrices based on Equation 228 are represented by the following equation.
In this case, i=0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1, and k=0, 1, . . . , M−2, M−1.
Precoding matrices F[0]-F[N×M−1] are thus generated (the precoding matrices F[0]-F[N×M−1] may be in any order for the N×M slots in the period (cycle)). Symbol number N×M×i may be precoded using F[0], symbol number N×M×i+1 may be precoded using F[1], . . . , and symbol number N×M×i+h may be precoded using F[h], for example (h=0, 1, 2, . . . , N×M−2, N×M−1). (In this case, as described in previous embodiments, precoding matrices need not be hopped between regularly.)
Generating the precoding matrices in this way achieves a precoding matrix hopping scheme with a large period (cycle), allowing for the position of poor reception points to be easily changed, which may lead to improved data reception quality. Note that while the N×M period (cycle) precoding matrices have been set to Equation 229, the N×M period (cycle) precoding matrices may be set to the following equation, as described above.
In this case, i=0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1, and k=0, 1, . . . , M−2, M−1.
In Equations 229 and 230, when 0 radians ≤δ≤2π radians, the matrices are a unitary matrix when δ=π radians and are a non-unitary matrix when δ≠π radians. In the present scheme, use of a non-unitary matrix for π/2 radians ≤|δ|<π radians is one characteristic structure (the conditions for δ being similar to other embodiments), and excellent data reception quality is obtained. Use of a unitary matrix is another structure, and as described in detail in Embodiment 10 and Embodiment 16, if N is an odd number in Equations 229 and 230, the probability of obtaining excellent data reception quality increases.
The present embodiment describes a scheme for regularly hopping between precoding matrices using a unitary matrix.
As described in Embodiment 8, in the scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices over a period (cycle) with N slots, the precoding matrices prepared for the N slots with reference to Equations 82-85 are represented as follows.
In this case, i=0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1. (Let α>0.) Since a unitary matrix is used in the present embodiment, the precoding matrices in Equation 231 may be represented as follows.
In this case, i=0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1. (Let α>0.) From Condition #5 (Math 106) and Condition #6 (Math 107) in Embodiment 3, the following condition is important for achieving excellent data reception quality.
Math 243
ej(θ
(x is 0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1; y is 0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1; and x≠y.)
Math 244
ej(θ
(x is 0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1; y is 0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1; and x≠y.)
Embodiment 6 describes the distance between poor reception points. In order to increase the distance between poor reception points, it is important for the number of slots N to be an odd number three or greater. The following explains this point.
In order to distribute the poor reception points evenly with regards to phase in the complex plane, as described in Embodiment 6, Condition #19 and Condition #20 are provided.
In other words, Condition #19 means that the difference in phase is 2π/N radians. On the other hand, Condition #20 means that the difference in phase is −2π/N radians.
Letting θ11(0)−θ21(0)=0 radians, and letting α<1, the distribution of poor reception points for s1 and for s2 in the complex plane for an N=3 period (cycle) is shown in
In this case, when considering the phase between a line segment from the origin to a poor reception point and a half line along the real axis defined by real ≥0 (see
Based on the above, considering how the case always occurs wherein the phase for the poor reception points for s1 and the phase for the poor reception points for s2 are the same value when the number of slots N in the period (cycle) is an even number, setting the number of slots N in the period (cycle) to an odd number increases the probability of a greater distance between poor reception points in the complex plane as compared to when the number of slots N in the period (cycle) is an even number. However, when the number of slots N in the period (cycle) is small, for example when N≤16, the minimum distance between poor reception points in the complex plane can be guaranteed to be a certain length, since the number of poor reception points is small. Accordingly, when N≤16, even if N is an even number, cases do exist where data reception quality can be guaranteed.
Therefore, in the scheme for regularly hopping between precoding matrices based on Equation 232, when the number of slots N in the period (cycle) is set to an odd number, the probability of improving data reception quality is high. Precoding matrices F[0]-F[N−1] are generated based on Equation 232 (the precoding matrices F[0]-F[N−1] may be in any order for the N slots in the period (cycle)). Symbol number Ni may be precoded using F[0], symbol number Ni+1 may be precoded using F[1], . . . , and symbol number N×i+h may be precoded using F[h], for example (h=0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1). (In this case, as described in previous embodiments, precoding matrices need not be hopped between regularly.) Furthermore, when the modulation scheme for both s1 and s2 is 16QAM, if α is set as follows,
the advantageous effect of increasing the minimum distance between 16×16=256 signal points in the I-Q plane for a specific LOS environment may be achieved.
In the present embodiment, the scheme of structuring N different precoding matrices for a precoding hopping scheme with an N-slot time period (cycle) has been described. In this case, as the N different precoding matrices, F[0], F[1], F[2], . . . , F[N−2], F[N−1] are prepared. In the present embodiment, an example of a single carrier transmission scheme has been described, and therefore the case of arranging symbols in the order F[0], F[1], F[2], . . . , F[N−2], F[N−1] in the time domain (or the frequency domain) has been described. The present invention is not, however, limited in this way, and the N different precoding matrices F[0], F[1], F[2], . . . , F[N−2], F[N−1] generated in the present embodiment may be adapted to a multi-carrier transmission scheme such as an OFDM transmission scheme or the like. As in Embodiment 1, as a scheme of adaption in this case, precoding weights may be changed by arranging symbols in the frequency domain and in the frequency-time domain. Note that a precoding hopping scheme with an N-slot time period (cycle) has been described, but the same advantageous effects may be obtained by randomly using N different precoding matrices. In other words, the N different precoding matrices do not necessarily need to be used in a regular period (cycle).
Furthermore, in the precoding matrix hopping scheme over an H-slot period (cycle) (H being a natural number larger than the number of slots N in the period (cycle) of the above scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices), when the N different precoding matrices of the present embodiment are included, the probability of excellent reception quality increases. In this case, Condition #17 and Condition #18 can be replaced by the following conditions. (The number of slots in the period (cycle) is considered to be N.)
Math 248
ej(θ
(x is 0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1; y is 0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1; and x≠y.)
Math 249
ej(θ
(x is 0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1; y is 0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1; and x≠y.)
The present embodiment describes a scheme for regularly hopping between precoding matrices using a unitary matrix that differs from the example in Embodiment 9.
In the scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices over a period (cycle) with 2N slots, the precoding matrices prepared for the 2N slots are represented as follows.
Let α be a fixed value (not depending on i), where α>0.
Let α be a fixed value (not depending on i), where α>0. (Let the a in Equation 234 and the α in Equation 235 be the same value.)
From Condition #5 (Math 106) and Condition #6 (Math 107) in Embodiment 3, the following conditions are important in Equation 234 for achieving excellent data reception quality.
Math 252
ej(θ
(x is 0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1; y is 0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1; and x≠y.)
Math 253
ej(θ
(x is 0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1; y is 0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1; and x≠y.)
Addition of the following condition is considered.
Math 254
θ11(x)=θ11(x+N) for ∀x(x=0,1,2, . . . ,N−2,N−1)
and
θ21(y)=θ21(y+N) for ∀y(y=0,1,2, . . . ,N−2,N−1) Condition #23
Next, in order to distribute the poor reception points evenly with regards to phase in the complex plane, as described in Embodiment 6, Condition #24 and Condition #25 are provided.
In other words, Condition #24 means that the difference in phase is 2π/N radians. On the other hand, Condition #25 means that the difference in phase is −2π/N radians.
Letting θ11(0)−θ21(0)=0 radians, and letting α>1, the distribution of poor reception points for s1 and for s2 in the complex plane when N=4 is shown in
Therefore, in the scheme for regularly hopping between precoding matrices based on Equations 234 and 235, when N is set to an odd number, the probability of improving data reception quality is high. Precoding matrices F[0]-F[2N−1] are generated based on Equations 234 and 235 (the precoding matrices F[0]-F[2N−1] may be arranged in any order for the 2N slots in the period (cycle)). Symbol number 2Ni may be precoded using F[0], symbol number 2Ni+1 may be precoded using F[1], . . . , and symbol number 2N×i+h may be precoded using F[h], for example (h=0, 1, 2, . . . , 2N−2, 2N−1). (In this case, as described in previous embodiments, precoding matrices need not be hopped between regularly.) Furthermore, when the modulation scheme for both s1 and s2 is 16QAM, if α is set as in Equation 233, the advantageous effect of increasing the minimum distance between 16×16=256 signal points in the I-Q plane for a specific LOS environment may be achieved.
The following conditions are possible as conditions differing from Condition #23:
Math 257
ej(θ
(where x is N, N+1, N+2, . . . , 2N−2, 2N−1; y is N, N+1, N+2, . . . , 2N−2, 2N−1; and x≠y.)
Math 258
ej(θ
(where x is N, N+1, N+2, . . . , 2N−2, 2N−1; y is N, N+1, N+2, . . . , 2N−2, 2N−1; and x≠y.)
In this case, by satisfying Condition #21, Condition #22, Condition #26, and Condition #27, the distance in the complex plane between poor reception points for s1 is increased, as is the distance between poor reception points for s2, thereby achieving excellent data reception quality.
In the present embodiment, the scheme of structuring 2N different precoding matrices for a precoding hopping scheme with a 2N-slot time period (cycle) has been described. In this case, as the 2N different precoding matrices, F[0], F[1], F[2], . . . , F[2N−2], F[2N−1] are prepared. In the present embodiment, an example of a single carrier transmission scheme has been described, and therefore the case of arranging symbols in the order F[0], F[1], F[2], . . . , F[2N−2], F[2N−1] in the time domain (or the frequency domain) has been described. The present invention is not, however, limited in this way, and the 2N different precoding matrices F[0], F[1], F[2], . . . , F[2N−2], F[2N−1] generated in the present embodiment may be adapted to a multi-carrier transmission scheme such as an OFDM transmission scheme or the like. As in Embodiment 1, as a scheme of adaption in this case, precoding weights may be changed by arranging symbols in the frequency domain and in the frequency-time domain. Note that a precoding hopping scheme with a 2N-slot time period (cycle) has been described, but the same advantageous effects may be obtained by randomly using 2N different precoding matrices. In other words, the 2N different precoding matrices do not necessarily need to be used in a regular period (cycle).
Furthermore, in the precoding matrix hopping scheme over an H-slot period (cycle) (H being a natural number larger than the number of slots 2N in the period (cycle) of the above scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices), when the 2N different precoding matrices of the present embodiment are included, the probability of excellent reception quality increases.
The present embodiment describes a scheme for regularly hopping between precoding matrices using a non-unitary matrix.
In the scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices over a period (cycle) with 2N slots, the precoding matrices prepared for the 2N slots are represented as follows.
Let α be a fixed value (not depending on i), where α>0. Furthermore, let δ≠π radians.
Let α be a fixed value (not depending on i), where α>0. (Let the α in Equation 236 and the α in Equation 237 be the same value.)
From Condition #5 (Math 106) and Condition #6 (Math 107) in Embodiment 3, the following conditions are important in Equation 236 for achieving excellent data reception quality.
Math 261
ej(θ
(x is 0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1; y is 0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1; and x≠y.)
Math 262
ej(θ
(x is 0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1; y is 0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1; and x≠y.)
Addition of the following condition is considered.
Math 263
θ11(x)=θ11(x+N) for ∀x(x=0,1,2, . . . ,N−2,N−1)
and
θ21(y)=θ21(y+N) for ∀y(y=0,1,2, . . . ,N−2,N−1) Condition #30
Note that instead of Equation 237, the precoding matrices in the following Equation may be provided.
Let α be a fixed value (not depending on i), where α>0. (Let the α in Equation 236 and the α in Equation 238 be the same value.)
As an example, in order to distribute the poor reception points evenly with regards to phase in the complex plane, as described in Embodiment 6, Condition #31 and Condition #32 are provided.
In other words, Condition #31 means that the difference in phase is 2π/N radians. On the other hand, Condition #32 means that the difference in phase is −2π/N radians.
Letting θ11(0)−θ21(0)=0 radians, letting α>1, and letting δ=(3π)/4 radians, the distribution of poor reception points for s1 and for s2 in the complex plane when N=4 is shown in
The following conditions are possible as conditions differing from Condition #30:
In this case, by satisfying Condition #28, Condition #29, Condition #33, and Condition #34, the distance in the complex plane between poor reception points for s1 is increased, as is the distance between poor reception points for s2, thereby achieving excellent data reception quality.
In the present embodiment, the scheme of structuring 2N different precoding matrices for a precoding hopping scheme with a 2N-slot time period (cycle) has been described. In this case, as the 2N different precoding matrices, F[0], F[1], F[2], . . . , F[2N−2], F[2N−1] are prepared. In the present embodiment, an example of a single carrier transmission scheme has been described, and therefore the case of arranging symbols in the order F[0], F[1], F[2], . . . , F[2N−2], F[2N−1] in the time domain (or the frequency domain) has been described. The present invention is not, however, limited in this way, and the 2N different precoding matrices F[0], F[1], F[2], . . . , F[2N−2], F[2N−1] generated in the present embodiment may be adapted to a multi-carrier transmission scheme such as an OFDM transmission scheme or the like. As in Embodiment 1, as a scheme of adaption in this case, precoding weights may be changed by arranging symbols in the frequency domain and in the frequency-time domain. Note that a precoding hopping scheme with a 2N-slot time period (cycle) has been described, but the same advantageous effects may be obtained by randomly using 2N different precoding matrices. In other words, the 2N different precoding matrices do not necessarily need to be used in a regular period (cycle).
Furthermore, in the precoding matrix hopping scheme over an H-slot period (cycle) (H being a natural number larger than the number of slots 2N in the period (cycle) of the above scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices), when the 2N different precoding matrices of the present embodiment are included, the probability of excellent reception quality increases.
The present embodiment describes a scheme for regularly hopping between precoding matrices using a non-unitary matrix.
In the scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices over a period (cycle) with N slots, the precoding matrices prepared for the N slots are represented as follows.
Let α be a fixed value (not depending on i), where α>0. Furthermore, let δ≠π radians (a fixed value not depending on i), and i=0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1.
From Condition #5 (Math 106) and Condition #6 (Math 107) in Embodiment 3, the following conditions are important in Equation 239 for achieving excellent data reception quality.
Math 270
ej(θ
(x is 0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1; y is 0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1; and x≠y.)
Math 271
ej(θ
(x is 0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1; y is 0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1; and x≠y.)
As an example, in order to distribute the poor reception points evenly with regards to phase in the complex plane, as described in Embodiment 6, Condition #37 and Condition #38 are provided.
In other words, Condition #37 means that the difference in phase is 2π/N radians. On the other hand, Condition #38 means that the difference in phase is −2π/N radians.
In this case, if π/2 radians ≤|δ|<π radians, α>0, and α≠1, the distance in the complex plane between poor reception points for s1 is increased, as is the distance between poor reception points for s2, thereby achieving excellent data reception quality. Note that Condition #37 and Condition #38 are not always necessary.
In the present embodiment, the scheme of structuring N different precoding matrices for a precoding hopping scheme with an N-slot time period (cycle) has been described. In this case, as the N different precoding matrices, F[0], F[1], F[2], . . . , F[N−2], F[N−1] are prepared. In the present embodiment, an example of a single carrier transmission scheme has been described, and therefore the case of arranging symbols in the order F[0], F[1], F[2], . . . , F[N−2], F[N−1] in the time domain (or the frequency domain) has been described. The present invention is not, however, limited in this way, and the N different precoding matrices F[0], F[1], F[2], . . . , F[N−2], F[N−1] generated in the present embodiment may be adapted to a multi-carrier transmission scheme such as an OFDM transmission scheme or the like. As in Embodiment 1, as a scheme of adaption in this case, precoding weights may be changed by arranging symbols in the frequency domain and in the frequency-time domain. Note that a precoding hopping scheme with an N-slot time period (cycle) has been described, but the same advantageous effects may be obtained by randomly using N different precoding matrices. In other words, the N different precoding matrices do not necessarily need to be used in a regular period (cycle).
Furthermore, in the precoding matrix hopping scheme over an H-slot period (cycle) (H being a natural number larger than the number of slots N in the period (cycle) of the above scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices), when the N different precoding matrices of the present embodiment are included, the probability of excellent reception quality increases. In this case, Condition #35 and Condition #36 can be replaced by the following conditions. (The number of slots in the period (cycle) is considered to be N.)
Math 274
ej(θ
(x is 0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1; y is 0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1; and x≠y.)
Math 275
ej(θ
(x is 0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1; is 0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1; and x≠y.)
The present embodiment describes a different example than Embodiment 8.
In the scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices over a period (cycle) with 2N slots, the precoding matrices prepared for the 2N slots are represented as follows.
Let α be a fixed value (not depending on i), where α>0. Furthermore, let δ≠π radians.
Let α be a fixed value (not depending on i), where α>0. (Let the α in Equation 240 and the α in Equation 241 be the same value.)
Furthermore, the 2×N×M period (cycle) precoding matrices based on Equations 240 and 241 are represented by the following equations.
In this case, k=0, 1, . . . , M−2, M−1.
In this case, k=0, 1, . . . , M−2, M−1. Furthermore, Xk=Yk may be true, or Xk≠Yk may be true.
Precoding matrices F[0]-F[2×N×M−1] are thus generated (the precoding matrices F[0]-F[2×N×M−1] may be in any order for the 2×N×M slots in the period (cycle)). Symbol number 2×N×M×i may be precoded using F[0], symbol number 2×N×M×i+1 may be precoded using F[1], . . . , and symbol number 2×N×M×i+h may be precoded using F[h], for example (h=0, 1, 2, . . . , 2×N×M−2, 2×N×M−1). (In this case, as described in previous embodiments, precoding matrices need not be hopped between regularly.)
Generating the precoding matrices in this way achieves a precoding matrix hopping scheme with a large period (cycle), allowing for the position of poor reception points to be easily changed, which may lead to improved data reception quality.
The 2×N×M period (cycle) precoding matrices in Equation 242 may be changed to the following equation.
In this case, k=0, 1, . . . , M−2, M−1.
The 2×N×M period (cycle) precoding matrices in Equation 243 may also be changed to any of Equations 245-247.
In this case, k=0, 1, . . . , M−2, M−1.
In this case, k=0, 1, . . . , M−2, M−1.
In this case, k=0, 1, . . . , M−2, M−1.
Focusing on poor reception points, if Equations 242 through 247 satisfy the following conditions,
Math 284
ej(θ
(x is 0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1; is 0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1; and x≠y.)
Math 285
ej(θ
(x is 0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1; is 0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1; and x≠y.)
Math 286
θ11(x)=θ11(x+N) for ∀x(x=0,1,2, . . . ,N−2,N−1)
and
θ21(y)=θ21(y+N) for ∀y(y=0,1,2, . . . ,N−2,N−1) Condition #41
then excellent data reception quality is achieved. Note that in Embodiment 8, Condition #39 and Condition #40 should be satisfied.
Focusing on Xk and Yk, if Equations 242 through 247 satisfy the following conditions,
Math 287
Xa≠Xb+2×s×π for ∀a,∀b(a≠b;a,b=0,1,2, . . . ,M−2,M−1) Condition #42
(a is 0, 1, 2, . . . , M−2, M−1; b is 0, 1, 2, . . . , M−2, M−1; and a≠b.)
(Here, s is an integer.)
Math 288
Ya≠Yb+2×u×π for ∀a,∀b(a≠b;a,b=0,1,2, . . . ,M−2,M−1) Condition #43
(a is 0, 1, 2, . . . , M−2, M−1; b is 0, 1, 2, . . . , M−2, M−1; and a≠b.)
(Here, u is an integer.)
then excellent data reception quality is achieved. Note that in Embodiment 8, Condition #42 should be satisfied.
In Equations 242 and 247, when 0 radians ≤δ<2π radians, the matrices are a unitary matrix when δ=π radians and are a non-unitary matrix when δ≠π radians. In the present scheme, use of a non-unitary matrix for π/2 radians ≤|δ|<π radians is one characteristic structure, and excellent data reception quality is obtained. Use of a unitary matrix is another structure, and as described in detail in Embodiment 10 and Embodiment 16, if N is an odd number in Equations 242 through 247, the probability of obtaining excellent data reception quality increases.
The present embodiment describes an example of differentiating between usage of a unitary matrix and a non-unitary matrix as the precoding matrix in the scheme for regularly hopping between precoding matrices.
The following describes an example that uses a two-by-two precoding matrix (letting each element be a complex number), i.e. the case when two modulated signals (s1(t) and s2(t)) that are based on a modulation scheme are precoded, and the two precoded signals are transmitted by two antennas.
When transmitting data using a scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices, the mapping units 306A and 306B in the transmission device in
The advantage of the scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices is that, as described in Embodiment 6, excellent data reception quality is achieved in an LOS environment. In particular, when the reception device performs ML calculation or applies APP (or Max-log APP) based on ML calculation, the advantageous effect is considerable. Incidentally, ML calculation greatly impacts circuit scale (calculation scale) in accordance with the modulation level of the modulation scheme. For example, when two precoded signals are transmitted from two antennas, and the same modulation scheme is used for two modulated signals (signals based on the modulation scheme before precoding), the number of candidate signal points in the I-Q plane (received signal points 1101 in
When such a reception device is assumed, consideration of the Signal-to-Noise Power Ratio (SNR) after separation of multiple signals indicates that a unitary matrix is appropriate as the precoding matrix when the reception device performs linear operation such as MMSE or ZF, whereas either a unitary matrix or a non-unitary matrix may be used when the reception device performs ML calculation. Taking any of the above embodiments into consideration, when two precoded signals are transmitted from two antennas, the same modulation scheme is used for two modulated signals (signals based on the modulation scheme before precoding), a non-unitary matrix is used as the precoding matrix in the scheme for regularly hopping between precoding matrices, the modulation level of the modulation scheme is equal to or less than 64 (or equal to or less than 256), and a unitary matrix is used when the modulation level is greater than 64 (or greater than 256), then for all of the modulation schemes supported by the transmission system, there is an increased probability of achieving the advantageous effect whereby excellent data reception quality is achieved for any of the modulation schemes while reducing the circuit scale of the reception device.
When the modulation level of the modulation scheme is equal to or less than 64 (or equal to or less than 256) as well, in some cases use of a unitary matrix may be preferable. Based on this consideration, when a plurality of modulation schemes are supported in which the modulation level is equal to or less than 64 (or equal to or less than 256), it is important that in some cases, in some of the plurality of supported modulation schemes where the modulation level is equal to or less than 64, a non-unitary matrix is used as the precoding matrix in the scheme for regularly hopping between precoding matrices.
The case of transmitting two precoded signals from two antennas has been described above as an example, but the present invention is not limited in this way. In the case when N precoded signals are transmitted from N antennas, and the same modulation scheme is used for N modulated signals (signals based on the modulation scheme before precoding), a threshold βN may be established for the modulation level of the modulation scheme. When α plurality of modulation schemes for which the modulation level is equal to or less than βN are supported, in some of the plurality of supported modulation schemes where the modulation level is equal to or less than βN, a non-unitary matrix is used as the precoding matrices in the scheme for regularly hopping between precoding matrices, whereas for modulation schemes for which the modulation level is greater than βN, a unitary matrix is used. In this way, for all of the modulation schemes supported by the transmission system, there is an increased probability of achieving the advantageous effect whereby excellent data reception quality is achieved for any of the modulation schemes while reducing the circuit scale of the reception device. (When the modulation level of the modulation scheme is equal to or less than βN, a non-unitary matrix may always be used as the precoding matrix in the scheme for regularly hopping between precoding matrices.)
In the above description, the same modulation scheme has been described as being used in the modulation scheme for simultaneously transmitting N modulated signals. The following, however, describes the case in which two or more modulation schemes are used for simultaneously transmitting N modulated signals.
As an example, the case in which two precoded signals are transmitted by two antennas is described. The two modulated signals (signals based on the modulation scheme before precoding) are either modulated with the same modulation scheme, or when modulated with different modulation schemes, are modulated with a modulation scheme having a modulation level of 2a1 or a modulation level of 2a2. In this case, when the reception device uses ML calculation ((Max-log) APP based on ML calculation), the number of candidate signal points in the I-Q plane (received signal points 1101 in
Furthermore, when 2a1+a2≤2β, in some cases use of a unitary matrix may be preferable. Based on this consideration, when a plurality of combinations of modulation schemes are supported for which 2a1+a2≤2β, it is important that in some of the supported combinations of modulation schemes for which 2a1+a2≤2β, a non-unitary matrix is used as the precoding matrix in the scheme for regularly hopping between precoding matrices.
As an example, the case in which two precoded signals are transmitted by two antennas has been described, but the present invention is not limited in this way. For example, N modulated signals (signals based on the modulation scheme before precoding) may be either modulated with the same modulation scheme or, when modulated with different modulation schemes, the modulation level of the modulation scheme for the ith modulated signal may be 2ai (where i=1, 2, . . . , N−1, N).
In this case, when the reception device uses ML calculation ((Max-log) APP based on ML calculation), the number of candidate signal points in the I-Q plane (received signal points 1101 in
When a plurality of combinations of a modulation schemes satisfying Condition #44 are supported, in some of the supported combinations of modulation schemes satisfying Condition #44, a non-unitary matrix is used as the precoding matrix in the scheme for regularly hopping between precoding matrices.
By using a unitary matrix in all of the combinations of modulation schemes satisfying Condition #45, then for all of the modulation schemes supported by the transmission system, there is an increased probability of achieving the advantageous effect whereby excellent data reception quality is achieved while reducing the circuit scale of the reception device for any of the combinations of modulation schemes. (A non-unitary matrix may be used as the precoding matrix in the scheme for regularly hopping between precoding matrices in all of the supported combinations of modulation schemes satisfying Condition #44.)
The present embodiment describes an example of a system that adopts a scheme for regularly hopping between precoding matrices using a multi-carrier transmission scheme such as OFDM.
In
Next, the supported transmission schemes are described.
When a scheme for transmitting one modulated signal is supported, from the standpoint of transmission power, Equation 250 may be represented as Equation 251.
When the information 315 regarding the weighting scheme indicates a MIMO system in which precoding matrices are regularly hopped between, signal processing in scheme #2, for example, of
Here, θ11, θ12, λ, and δ are fixed values.
In
A modulated signal generating unit #1 (5201_1) receives, as input, information (5200_1) and the control signal (5206) and, based on the information on the transmission scheme in the control signal (5206), outputs a modulated signal z1 (5202_1) and a modulated signal z2 (5203_1) in the carrier group # A of
Similarly, a modulated signal generating unit #2 (5201_2) receives, as input, information (5200_2) and the control signal (5206) and, based on the information on the transmission scheme in the control signal (5206), outputs a modulated signal z1 (5202_2) and a modulated signal z2 (5203_2) in the carrier group # B of
Similarly, a modulated signal generating unit #3 (5201_3) receives, as input, information (5200_3) and the control signal (5206) and, based on the information on the transmission scheme in the control signal (5206), outputs a modulated signal z1 (5202_3) and a modulated signal z2 (5203_3) in the carrier group # C of
Similarly, a modulated signal generating unit #4 (5201_4) receives, as input, information (5200_4) and the control signal (5206) and, based on the information on the transmission scheme in the control signal (5206), outputs a modulated signal z1 (5202_4) and a modulated signal z2 (5203_4) in the carrier group # D of
While not shown in the figures, the same is true for modulated signal generating unit #5 through modulated signal generating unit # M−1.
Similarly, a modulated signal generating unit # M (5201_M) receives, as input, information (5200_M) and the control signal (5206) and, based on the information on the transmission scheme in the control signal (5206), outputs a modulated signal z1 (5202_M) and a modulated signal z2 (5203_M) in a certain carrier group.
An OFDM related processor (5207_1) receives, as inputs, the modulated signal z1 (5202_1) in carrier group # A, the modulated signal z1 (5202_2) in carrier group # B, the modulated signal z1 (5202_3) in carrier group # C, the modulated signal z1 (5202_4) in carrier group # D, . . . , the modulated signal z1 (5202_M) in a certain carrier group # M, and the control signal (5206), performs processing such as reordering, inverse Fourier transform, frequency conversion, amplification, and the like, and outputs a transmission signal (5208_1). The transmission signal (5208_1) is output as a radio wave from an antenna (5209_1).
Similarly, an OFDM related processor (5207_2) receives, as inputs, the modulated signal z1 (5203_1) in carrier group # A, the modulated signal z1 (5203_2) in carrier group # B, the modulated signal z1 (5203_3) in carrier group # C, the modulated signal z1 (5203_4) in carrier group # D, . . . , the modulated signal z1 (5203_M) in a certain carrier group # M, and the control signal (5206), performs processing such as reordering, inverse Fourier transform, frequency conversion, amplification, and the like, and outputs a transmission signal (5208_2). The transmission signal (5208_2) is output as a radio wave from an antenna (5209_2).
An interleaver (5304) receives, as input, error correction coded data (5303) and the control signal (5301) and, in accordance with information on the interleaving scheme included in the control signal (5301), reorders the error correction coded data (5303) and outputs interleaved data (5305).
A mapping unit (5306_1) receives, as input, the interleaved data (5305) and the control signal (5301) and, in accordance with the information on the modulation scheme included in the control signal (5301), performs mapping and outputs a baseband signal (5307_1).
Similarly, a mapping unit (5306_2) receives, as input, the interleaved data (5305) and the control signal (5301) and, in accordance with the information on the modulation scheme included in the control signal (5301), performs mapping and outputs a baseband signal (5307_2).
A signal processing unit (5308) receives, as input, the baseband signal (5307_1), the baseband signal (5307_2), and the control signal (5301) and, based on information on the transmission scheme (for example, in this embodiment, a spatial multiplexing MIMO system, a MIMO scheme using a fixed precoding matrix, a MIMO scheme for regularly hopping between precoding matrices, space-time block coding, or a transmission scheme for transmitting only stream s1) included in the control signal (5301), performs signal processing. The signal processing unit (5308) outputs a processed signal z1 (5309_1) and a processed signal z2 (5309_2). Note that when the transmission scheme for transmitting only stream s1 is selected, the signal processing unit (5308) does not output the processed signal z2 (5309_2). Furthermore, in
The control information symbols are for transmitting control information shared by the carrier group and are composed of symbols for the transmission and reception devices to perform frequency and time synchronization, information regarding the allocation of (sub)carriers, and the like. The control information symbols are set to be transmitted from only stream s1 at time $1.
The individual control information symbols are for transmitting control information on individual subcarrier groups and are composed of information on the transmission scheme, modulation scheme, error correction coding scheme, coding rate for error correction coding, block size of error correction codes, and the like for the data symbols, information on the insertion scheme of pilot symbols, information on the transmission power of pilot symbols, and the like. The individual control information symbols are set to be transmitted from only stream s1 at time $1.
The data symbols are for transmitting data (information), and as described with reference to
The pilot symbols are for the reception device to perform channel estimation, i.e. to estimate fluctuation corresponding to h11(t), h12(t), h21(t), and h22(t) in Equation 36. (In this embodiment, since a multi-carrier transmission scheme such as an OFDM scheme is used, the pilot symbols are for estimating fluctuation corresponding to h11(t), h12(t), h21(t), and h22(t) in each subcarrier.) Accordingly, the PSK transmission scheme, for example, is used for the pilot symbols, which are structured to form a pattern known by the transmission and reception devices. Furthermore, the reception device may use the pilot symbols for estimation of frequency offset, estimation of phase distortion, and time synchronization.
In
The control information decoding unit 709 in
The channel fluctuation estimating unit 705_1 for the modulated signal z1 receives, as inputs, the processed signal 704_X and the control signal 710, performs channel estimation in the carrier group required by the reception device (the desired carrier group), and outputs a channel estimation signal 706_1.
Similarly, the channel fluctuation estimating unit 705_2 for the modulated signal z2 receives, as inputs, the processed signal 704_X and the control signal 710, performs channel estimation in the carrier group required by the reception device (the desired carrier group), and outputs a channel estimation signal 706_2.
Similarly, the channel fluctuation estimating unit 705_1 for the modulated signal z1 receives, as inputs, the processed signal 704_Y and the control signal 710, performs channel estimation in the carrier group required by the reception device (the desired carrier group), and outputs a channel estimation signal 708_1.
Similarly, the channel fluctuation estimating unit 705_2 for the modulated signal z2 receives, as inputs, the processed signal 704_Y and the control signal 710, performs channel estimation in the carrier group required by the reception device (the desired carrier group), and outputs a channel estimation signal 708_2.
The signal processing unit 711 receives, as inputs, the signals 706_1, 706_2, 708_1, 708_2, 704_X, 704_Y, and the control signal 710. Based on the information included in the control signal 710 on the transmission scheme, modulation scheme, error correction coding scheme, coding rate for error correction coding, block size of error correction codes, and the like for the data symbols transmitted in the desired carrier group, the signal processing unit 711 demodulates and decodes the data symbols and outputs received data 712.
A Fourier transformer (5703) receives, as input, the frequency converted signal (5702), performs a Fourier transform, and outputs a Fourier transformed signal (5704).
As described above, when using a multi-carrier transmission scheme such as an OFDM scheme, carriers are divided into a plurality of carrier groups, and the transmission scheme is set for each carrier group, thereby allowing for the reception quality and transmission speed to be set for each carrier group, which yields the advantageous effect of construction of a flexible system. In this case, as described in other embodiments, allowing for choice of a scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices offers the advantages of obtaining high reception quality, as well as high transmission speed, in an LOS environment. While in the present embodiment, the transmission schemes to which a carrier group can be set are “a spatial multiplexing MIMO system, a MIMO scheme using a fixed precoding matrix, a MIMO scheme for regularly hopping between precoding matrices, space-time block coding, or a transmission scheme for transmitting only stream s1”, but the transmission schemes are not limited in this way. Furthermore, the space-time coding is not limited to the scheme described with reference to
In
Like Embodiment 10, the present embodiment describes a scheme for regularly hopping between precoding matrices using a unitary matrix when N is an odd number.
In the scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices over a period (cycle) with 2N slots, the precoding matrices prepared for the 2N slots are represented as follows.
Let α be a fixed value (not depending on i), where α>0.
Let α be a fixed value (not depending on i), where α>0. (Let the α in Equation 253 and the α in Equation 254 be the same value.)
From Condition #5 (Math 106) and Condition #6 (Math 107) in Embodiment 3, the following conditions are important in Equation 253 for achieving excellent data reception quality.
Math 296
ej(θ
(x is 0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1; y is 0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1; and x≠y.)
Math 297
ej(θ
(x is 0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1; y is 0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1; and x≠y.)
Addition of the following condition is considered.
Math 298
θ11(x)=θ11(x+N) for ∀x(x=0,1,2, . . . ,N−2,N−1)
and
θ21(y)=θ21(y+N) for ∀y(y=0,1,2, . . . ,N−2,N−1) Condition #48
Next, in order to distribute the poor reception points evenly with regards to phase in the complex plane, as described in Embodiment 6, Condition #49 and Condition #50 are provided.
In other words, Condition #49 means that the difference in phase is 2π/N radians. On the other hand, Condition #50 means that the difference in phase is −2π/N radians.
Letting θ11(0)−θ21(0)=0 radians, and letting α>1, the distribution of poor reception points for s1 and for s2 in the complex plane for N=3 is shown in
Therefore, in the scheme for regularly hopping between precoding matrices based on Equations 253 and 254, when N is set to an odd number, the probability of improving data reception quality is high. Precoding matrices F[0]-F[2N−1] are generated based on Equations 253 and 254 (the precoding matrices F[0]-F[2N−1] may be in any order for the 2N slots in the period (cycle)). Symbol number 2Ni may be precoded using F[0], symbol number 2Ni+1 may be precoded using F[1], . . . , and symbol number 2N×i+h may be precoded using F[h], for example (h=0, 1, 2, . . . , 2N−2, 2N−1). (In this case, as described in previous embodiments, precoding matrices need not be hopped between regularly.) Furthermore, when the modulation scheme for both s1 and s2 is 16QAM, if α is set as in Equation 233, the advantageous effect of increasing the minimum distance between 16×16=256 signal points in the I-Q plane for a specific LOS environment may be achieved.
The following conditions are possible as conditions differing from Condition #48:
Math 301
ej(θ
(where x is N, N+1, N+2, . . . , 2N−2, 2N−1; y is N, N+1, N+2, . . . , 2N−2, 2N−1; and x≠y)
Math 302
ej(θ
(where x is N, N+1, N+2, . . . , 2N−2, 2N−1; y is N, N+1, N+2, . . . , 2N−2, 2N−1; and x≠y)
In this case, by satisfying Condition #46, Condition #47, Condition #51, and Condition #52, the distance in the complex plane between poor reception points for s1 is increased, as is the distance between poor reception points for s2, thereby achieving excellent data reception quality.
In the present embodiment, the scheme of structuring 2N different precoding matrices for a precoding hopping scheme with a 2N-slot time period (cycle) has been described. In this case, as the 2N different precoding matrices, F[0], F[1], F[2], . . . , F[2N−2], F[2N−1] are prepared. In the present embodiment, an example of a single carrier transmission scheme has been described, and therefore the case of arranging symbols in the order F[0], F[1], F[2], . . . , F[2N−2], F[2N−1] in the time domain (or the frequency domain) has been described. The present invention is not, however, limited in this way, and the 2N different precoding matrices F[0], F[1], F[2], . . . , F[2N−2], F[2N−1] generated in the present embodiment may be adapted to a multi-carrier transmission scheme such as an OFDM transmission scheme or the like. As in Embodiment 1, as a scheme of adaption in this case, precoding weights may be changed by arranging symbols in the frequency domain and in the frequency-time domain. Note that a precoding hopping scheme with a 2N-slot time period (cycle) has been described, but the same advantageous effects may be obtained by randomly using 2N different precoding matrices. In other words, the 2N different precoding matrices do not necessarily need to be used in a regular period (cycle).
Furthermore, in the precoding matrix hopping scheme over an H-slot period (cycle) (H being a natural number larger than the number of slots 2N in the period (cycle) of the above scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices), when the 2N different precoding matrices of the present embodiment are included, the probability of excellent reception quality increases.
The present embodiment describes a concrete example of the scheme of regularly changing precoding weights, based on Embodiment 8.
At this point, when for example a precoding matrix hopping scheme with an N=8 period (cycle) as in Example #8 in Embodiment 6 is used, z1(t) and z2(t) are represented as follows. For symbol number 8i (where i is an integer greater than or equal to zero):
Here, j is an imaginary unit, and k=0.
For symbol number 8i+1:
Here, k=1.
For symbol number 8i+2:
Here, k=2.
For symbol number 8i+3:
Here, k=3.
For symbol number 8i+4:
Here, k=4.
For symbol number 8i+5:
Here, k=5.
For symbol number 8i+6:
Here, k=6.
For symbol number 8i+7:
Here, k=7.
The symbol numbers shown here can be considered to indicate time. As described in other embodiments, in Equation 262, for example, z1(8i+7) and z2(8i+7) at time 8i+7 are signals at the same time, and the transmission device transmits z1(8i+7) and z2(8i+7) over the same (shared/common) frequency. In other words, letting the signals at time T be s1(T), s2(T), z1(T), and z2(T), then z1(T) and z2(T) are sought from some sort of precoding matrices and from s1(T) and s2(T), and the transmission device transmits z1(T) and z2(T) over the same (shared/common) frequency (at the same time). Furthermore, in the case of using a multi-carrier transmission scheme such as OFDM or the like, and letting signals corresponding to s1, s2, z1, and z2 for (sub)carrier L and time T be s1(T, L), s2(T, L), z1(T, L), and z2(T, L), then z1(T, L) and z2(T, L) are sought from some sort of precoding matrices and from s1(T, L) and s2(T, L), and the transmission device transmits z1(T, L) and z2(T, L) over the same (shared/common) frequency (at the same time). In this case, the appropriate value of α is given by Equation 198 or Equation 200. Also, different values of α may be set in Equations 255-262. That is to say, when two equations (Equations λ and Y) are extracted from Equations 255-262, the value of α given by Equation X may be different from the value of α given by Equation Y.
The present embodiment describes a precoding hopping scheme that increases period (cycle) size, based on the above-described precoding matrices of Equation 190.
Letting the period (cycle) of the precoding hopping scheme be 8M, 8M different precoding matrices are represented as follows.
In this case, i=0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, and k=0, 1, . . . , M−2, M−1.
For example, letting M=2 and α<1, the poor reception points for s1 (∘) and for s2 (□) at k=0 are represented as in
Here, i=0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, and k=0, 1.
In this case, when M=2, precoding matrices F[0]-F[15] are generated (the precoding matrices F[0]-F[15] may be in any order. Also, matrices F[0]-F[15] may be different matrices). Symbol number 16i may be precoded using F[0], symbol number 16i+1 may be precoded using F[1], . . . , and symbol number 16i+h may be precoded using F[h], for example (h=0, 1, 2, . . . , 14, 15). (In this case, as described in previous embodiments, precoding matrices need not be hopped between regularly.) Summarizing the above considerations, with reference to Equations 82-85, N-period (cycle) precoding matrices are represented by the following equation.
Here, since the period (cycle) has N slots, i=0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1. Furthermore, the N×M period (cycle) precoding matrices based on Equation 265 are represented by the following equation.
In this case, i=0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1, and k=0, 1, . . . , M−2, M−1.
In this case, precoding matrices F[0]-F[N×M−1] are generated. (Precoding matrices F[0]-F[N×M−1] may be in any order for the N×M slots in the period (cycle)). Symbol number N×M×i may be precoded using F[0], symbol number N+1 may be precoded using F[1], . . . , and symbol number N×M×i+h may be precoded using F[h], for example (h=0, 1, 2, . . . , N×M−2, N×M−1). (In this case, as described in previous embodiments, precoding matrices need not be hopped between regularly.)
Generating the precoding matrices in this way achieves a precoding matrix hopping scheme with a large period (cycle), allowing for the position of poor reception points to be easily changed, which may lead to improved data reception quality. Note that while the N×M period (cycle) precoding matrices have been set to Equation 266, the N×M period (cycle) precoding matrices may be set to the following equation, as described above.
In this case, i=0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1, and k=0, 1, . . . , M−2, M−1.
In Equations 265 and 266, when 0 radians ≤δ<2π radians, the matrices are a unitary matrix when δ=π radians and are a non-unitary matrix when δ≠π radians. In the present scheme, use of a non-unitary matrix for π/2 radians ≤|δ|<π radians is one characteristic structure (the conditions for δ being similar to other embodiments), and excellent data reception quality is obtained. However, not limited to this, a unitary matrix may be used instead.
In the present embodiment, as one example of the case where λ is treated as a fixed value, a case where λ=0 radians is described. However, in view of the mapping according to the modulation scheme, λ may be set to a fixed value defined as λ=π/2 radians, λ=π radians, or λ=(3π)/2 radians. (For example, λ may be set to a fixed value defined as λ=π radians in the precoding matrices of the precoding scheme in which hopping between precoding matrices is performed regularly.) With this structure, as is the case where λ is set to a value defined as λ=0 radians, a reduction in circuit size is achieved.
The present embodiment describes a scheme for regularly hopping between precoding matrices using a unitary matrix based on Embodiment 9.
As described in Embodiment 8, in the scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices over a period (cycle) with N slots, the precoding matrices prepared for the N slots with reference to Equations 82-85 are represented as follows.
In this case, i=0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1. (α>0.) Since a unitary matrix is used in the present embodiment, the precoding matrices in Equation 268 may be represented as follows.
In this case, i=0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1. (α>0.) From Condition #5 (Math 106) and Condition #6 (Math 107) in Embodiment 3, the following condition is important for achieving excellent data reception quality.
Math 318
ej(θ
(x is 0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1; y is 0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1; and x≠y.)
Math 319
ej(θ
(x is 0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1; y is 0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1; and x≠y.)
Embodiment 6 has described the distance between poor reception points. In order to increase the distance between poor reception points, it is important for the number of slots N to be an odd number three or greater. The following explains this point.
In order to distribute the poor reception points evenly with regards to phase in the complex plane, as described in Embodiment 6, Condition #55 and Condition #56 are provided.
Letting θ11(0)−θ21(0)=0 radians, and letting α<1, the distribution of poor reception points for s1 and for s2 in the complex plane for an N=3 period (cycle) is shown in
In this case, when considering the phase between α line segment from the origin to a poor reception point and a half line along the real axis defined by real ≥0 (see
Based on the above, considering how the case always occurs wherein the phase for the poor reception points for s1 and the phase for the poor reception points for s2 are the same value when the number of slots N in the period (cycle) is an even number, setting the number of slots N in the period (cycle) to an odd number increases the probability of a greater distance between poor reception points in the complex plane as compared to when the number of slots N in the period (cycle) is an even number. However, when the number of slots N in the period (cycle) is small, for example when N≤16, the minimum distance between poor reception points in the complex plane can be guaranteed to be a certain length, since the number of poor reception points is small. Accordingly, when N≤16, even if N is an even number, cases do exist where data reception quality can be guaranteed.
Therefore, in the scheme for regularly hopping between precoding matrices based on Equation 269, when the number of slots N in the period (cycle) is set to an odd number, the probability of improving data reception quality is high. Precoding matrices F[0]-F[N−1] are generated based on Equation 269 (the precoding matrices F[0]-F[N−1] may be in any order for the N slots in the period (cycle)). Symbol number Ni may be precoded using F[0], symbol number Ni+1 may be precoded using F[1], . . . , and symbol number N×i+h may be precoded using F[h], for example (h=0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1). (In this case, as described in previous embodiments, precoding matrices need not be hopped between regularly.) Furthermore, when the modulation scheme for both s1 and s2 is 16QAM, if α is set as follows,
the advantageous effect of increasing the minimum distance between 16×16=256 signal points in the I-Q plane for a specific LOS environment may be achieved.
Also, when the modulation scheme for s1 is QPSK modulation and the modulation scheme for s2 is 16QAM, if α is set as follows,
the advantageous effect of increasing the minimum distance between candidate signal points in the I-Q plane for a specific LOS environment may be achieved.
Note that a signal point layout in the I-Q plane for 16QAM is shown in
h in
As an example of the precoding matrices prepared for the N slots based on Equation 269, the following matrices are considered:
Note that, in order to restrict the calculation scale of the above precoding in the transmission device, θ11(i)=0 radians and λ=0 radians may be set in Equation 269. In this case, however, in Equation 269, λ may vary depending on i, or may be the same value. That is to say, in Equation 269, λ in F[i=x] and λ F[i=y] (x≠y) may be the same value or may be different values.
As the value to which α is set, the above-described set value is one of effective values. However, not limited to this, α may be set, for example, for each value of i in the precoding matrix F[i] as described in Embodiment 17. (That is to say, in F[i], α is not necessarily be always set to a constant value for i).
In the present embodiment, the scheme of structuring N different precoding matrices for a precoding hopping scheme with an N-slot time period (cycle) has been described. In this case, as the N different precoding matrices, F[0], F[1], F[2], . . . , F[N−2], F[N−1] are prepared. In the single carrier transmission scheme, symbols are arranged in the order F[0], F[1], F[2], . . . , F[N−2], F[N−1] in the time domain (or the frequency domain in the case of the multi-carrier transmission scheme). The present invention is not, however, limited in this way, and the N different precoding matrices F[0], F[1], F[2], . . . , F[N−2], F[N−1] generated in the present embodiment may be adapted to a multi-carrier transmission scheme such as an OFDM transmission scheme or the like. As in Embodiment 1, as a scheme of adaptation in this case, precoding weights may be changed by arranging symbols in the frequency domain and in the frequency-time domain. Note that a precoding hopping scheme with an N-slot time period (cycle) has been described, but the same advantageous effects may be obtained by randomly using N different precoding matrices. In other words, the N different precoding matrices do not necessarily need to be used in a regular period (cycle).
Furthermore, in the precoding matrix hopping scheme over an H-slot period (cycle) (H being a natural number larger than the number of slots N in the period (cycle) of the above scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices), when the N different precoding matrices of the present embodiment are included, the probability of excellent reception quality increases. In this case, Condition #55 and Condition #56 can be replaced by the following conditions. (The number of slots in the period (cycle) is considered to be N.)
Math 331
ej(θ
(x is 0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1; y is 0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1; and x≠y.)
Math 332
ej(θ
(x is 0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1; y is 0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1; and x≠y.)
In the present embodiment, as one example of the case where λ is treated as a fixed value, a case where λ=0 radians is described. However, in view of the mapping according to the modulation scheme, λ may be set to a fixed value defined as λ=π/2 radians, λ=π radians, or λ=(3π)/2 radians. (For example, λ may be set to a fixed value defined as λ=π radians in the precoding matrices of the precoding scheme in which hopping between precoding matrices is performed regularly.) With this structure, as is the case where λ is set to a value defined as λ=0 radians, a reduction in circuit size is achieved.
The present embodiment describes a scheme for regularly hopping between precoding matrices using a unitary matrix based on Embodiment 10.
In the scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices over a period (cycle) with 2N slots, the precoding matrices prepared for the 2N slots are represented as follows.
α>0, and α is a fixed value (regardless of i).
α>0, and α is a fixed value (regardless of i).
(The value of α in Equation 279 is the same as the value of α in Equation 280.)
(The value of α may be set as α<0.)
From Condition #5 (Math 106) and Condition #6 (Math 107) in Embodiment 3, the following condition is important for achieving excellent data reception quality.
Math 335
ej(θ
(x is 0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1; y is 0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1; and x≠y.)
Math 336
ej(θ
is 0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1; y is 0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1; and x≠y.)
Addition of the following condition is considered.
Math 337
θ11(x)=θ11(x+N) for ∀x(x=0,1,2, . . . ,N−2,N−1)
and
θ21(y)=θ21(y+N) for ∀y(y=0,1,2, . . . ,N−2,N−1) Condition #59
Next, in order to distribute the poor reception points evenly with regards to phase in the complex plane, as described in Embodiment 6, Condition #60 and Condition #61 are provided.
Letting θ11(0)−θ21(0)=0 radians, and letting α>1, the distribution of poor reception points for s1 and for s2 in the complex plane for N=4 is shown in
Therefore, in the scheme for regularly hopping between precoding matrices based on Equations 279 and 280, when N is set to an odd number, the probability of improving data reception quality is high. Note that precoding matrices F[0]-F[2N−1] have been generated based on Equations 279 and 280. (The precoding matrices F[0]-F[2N−1] may be in any order for the 2N slots in the period (cycle)). Symbol number 2Ni may be precoded using F[0], symbol number 2Ni+1 may be precoded using F[1], . . . , and symbol number 2N×i+h may be precoded using F[h], for example (h=0, 1, 2, . . . , 2N−2, 2N−1). (In this case, as described in previous embodiments, precoding matrices need not be hopped between regularly.) Furthermore, when the modulation scheme for both s1 and s2 is 16QAM, if α is set as in Equation 270, the advantageous effect of increasing the minimum distance between 16×16=256 signal points in the I-Q plane for a specific LOS environment may be achieved.
Also, when the modulation scheme for s1 is QPSK modulation and the modulation scheme for s2 is 16QAM, if α is set as in Equation 271, the advantageous effect of increasing the minimum distance between candidate signal points in the I-Q plane for a specific LOS environment may be achieved. Note that a signal point layout in the I-Q plane for 16QAM is shown in
The following conditions are possible as conditions differing from Condition #59:
Math 340
ej(θ
(x is N, N+1, N+2, . . . , 2N−2, 2N−1; y is N, N+1, N+2, . . . , 2N−2, 2N−1; and x≠y.)
Math 341
ej(θ
(x is N, N+1, N+2, . . . , 2N−2, 2N−1; y is N, N+1, N+2, . . . , 2N−2, 2N−1; and x≠y.)
In this case, by satisfying Condition #57 and Condition #58 and Condition #62 and Condition #63, the distance in the complex plane between poor reception points for s1 is increased, as is the distance between poor reception points for s2, thereby achieving excellent data reception quality.
As an example of the precoding matrices prepared for the 2N slots based on Equations 279 and 280, the following matrices are considered when N=15:
Note that, in order to restrict the calculation scale of the above precoding in the transmission device, θ11(i)=0 radians and λ=0 radians may be set in Equation 279, and θ21(i)=0 radians and λ=0 radians may be set in Equation 280.
In this case, however, in Equations 279 and 280, λ may be set as a value that varies depending on i, or may be set as the same value. That is to say, in Equations 279 and 280, λ in F[i=x] and λ in F[i=y] (x≠y) may be the same value or may be different values. As another scheme, λ is set as a fixed value in Equation 279, λ is set as a fixed value in Equation 280, and the fixed values of λ in Equations 279 and 280 are set as different values. (As still another scheme, the fixed values of λ in Equations 279 and 280 are used.)
As the value to which α is set, the above-described set value is one of effective values. However, not limited to this, α may be set, for example, for each value of i in the precoding matrix F[i] as described in Embodiment 17. (That is to say, in F[i], α is not necessarily be always set to a constant value for i.)
In the present embodiment, the scheme of structuring 2N different precoding matrices for a precoding hopping scheme with a 2N-slot time period (cycle) has been described. In this case, as the 2N different precoding matrices, F[0], F[1], F[2], . . . , F[2N−2], F[2N−1] are prepared. In the single carrier transmission scheme, symbols are arranged in the order F[0], F[1], F[2], . . . , F[2N−2], F[2N−1] in the time domain (or the frequency domain in the case of the multi-carrier transmission scheme). The present invention is not, however, limited in this way, and the 2N different precoding matrices F[0], F[1], F[2], . . . , F[2N−2], F[2N−1] generated in the present embodiment may be adapted to a multi-carrier transmission scheme such as an OFDM transmission scheme or the like. As in Embodiment 1, as a scheme of adaptation in this case, precoding weights may be changed by arranging symbols in the frequency domain and in the frequency-time domain. Note that a precoding hopping scheme with a 2N-slot time period (cycle) has been described, but the same advantageous effects may be obtained by randomly using 2N different precoding matrices. In other words, the 2N different precoding matrices do not necessarily need to be used in a regular period (cycle).
Furthermore, in the precoding matrix hopping scheme over an H-slot period (cycle) (H being a natural number larger than the number of slots 2N in the period (cycle) of the above scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices), when the 2N different precoding matrices of the present embodiment are included, the probability of excellent reception quality increases.
In the present embodiment, as one example of the case where λ is treated as a fixed value, a case where λ=0 radians is described. However, in view of the mapping according to the modulation scheme, λ may be set to a fixed value defined as λ=π/2 radians, λ=π radians, or λ=(3π)/2 radians. (For example, λ may be set to a fixed value defined as λ=π radians in the precoding matrices of the precoding scheme in which hopping between precoding matrices is performed regularly.) With this structure, as is the case where λ is set to a value defined as λ=0 radians, a reduction in circuit size is achieved.
The present embodiment describes a scheme for regularly hopping between precoding matrices using a unitary matrix based on Embodiment 13.
In the scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices over a period (cycle) with 2N slots, the precoding matrices prepared for the 2N slots are represented as follows.
Let α be a fixed value (not depending on i), where α>0.
Let α be a fixed value (not depending on i), where α>0. (The value of α may be set as α<0.)
Furthermore, the 2×N×M period (cycle) precoding matrices based on Equations 311 and 312 are represented by the following equations.
In this case, k=0, 1, . . . , M−2, M−1.
In this case, k=0, 1, . . . , M−2, M−1. Furthermore, Xk=Yk may be true, or Xk≠Yk may be true.
In this case, precoding matrices F[0]-F[2N×M−1] are generated.
(Precoding matrices F[0]-F[2×N×M−1] may be in any order for the 2×N××M slots in the period (cycle)). Symbol number 2×N×M×i may be precoded using F[0], symbol number 2×N×M×i+1 may be precoded using F[1], . . . , and symbol number 2×N×M×i+h may be precoded using F[h], for example (h=0, 1, 2, . . . , 2×N×M−2, 2×N×M−1). (In this case, as described in previous embodiments, precoding matrices need not be hopped between regularly.)
Generating the precoding matrices in this way achieves a precoding matrix hopping scheme with a large period (cycle), allowing for the position of poor reception points to be easily changed, which may lead to improved data reception quality.
The 2×N×M period (cycle) precoding matrices in Equation 313 may be changed to the following equation.
In this case, k=0, 1, . . . , M−2, M−1.
The 2×N×M period (cycle) precoding matrices in Equation 314 may also be changed to any of Equations 316-318.
In this case, k=0, 1, . . . , M−2, M−1.
In this case, k=0, 1, . . . , M−2, M−1.
In this case, k=0, 1, . . . , M−2, M−1.
Focusing on poor reception points, if Equations 313 through 318 satisfy the following conditions,
Math 380
ej(θ
(x is 0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1; y is 0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1; and x≠y.)
Math 381
ej(θ
(x is 0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1; y is 0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1; and x≠y.)
Math 382
θ11(x)=θ11(x+N) for ∀x(x=0,1,2, . . . ,N−2,N−1)
and
θ21(y)=θ21(y+N) for ∀y(y=0,1,2, . . . ,N−2,N−1) Condition #66
then excellent data reception quality is achieved. Note that in Embodiment 8, Condition #39 and Condition #40 should be satisfied.
Focusing on Xk and Yk, if Equations 313 through 318 satisfy the following conditions,
Math 383
Xa≠Xb+2×s×π for ∀a,∀b(a≠b;a,b=0,1,2, . . . ,M−2,M−1) Condition #67
(a is 0, 1, 2, . . . , M−2, M−1; b is 0, 1, 2, . . . , M−2, M−1; and a≠b.) (Here, s is an integer.)
Math 384
Ya≠Yb+2×u×π for ∀a,∀b(a≠b;a,b=0,1,2, . . . ,M−2,M−1) Condition #68
(a is 0, 1, 2, . . . , M−2, M−1; b is 0, 1, 2, . . . , M−2, M−1; and a≠b.) (Here, u is an integer.),
then excellent data reception quality is achieved. Note that in Embodiment 8, Condition #42 should be satisfied. In Equations 313 and 318, when 0 radians ≤δ<2π radians, the matrices are a unitary matrix when δ=π radians and are a non-unitary matrix when δ≠π radians. In the present scheme, use of a non-unitary matrix for π/2 radians ≤|δ|<π radians is one characteristic structure, and excellent data reception quality is obtained, but use of a unitary matrix is also possible.
The following provides an example of precoding matrices in the precoding hopping scheme of the present embodiment. The following matrices are considered when N=5, M=2 as an example of the 2×N×M period (cycle) precoding matrices based on Equations 313 through 318:
In this way, in the above example, in order to restrict the calculation scale of the above precoding in the transmission device, X=0 radians, δ=π radians, X1=0 radians, and X2=π radians are set in Equation 313, and X=0 radians, δ=π radians, Y1=0 radians, and Y2=π radians are set in Equation 314. In this case, however, in Equations 313 and 314, λ may be set as a value that varies depending on i, or may be set as the same value. That is to say, in Equations 313 and 314, λ in F[i=x] and λ in F[i=y] (x≠y) may be the same value or may be different values. As another scheme, λ is set as a fixed value in Equation 313, λ is set as a fixed value in Equation 314, and the fixed values of λ in Equations 313 and 314 are set as different values. (As still another scheme, the fixed values of λ in Equations 313 and 314 are used.)
As the value to which α is set, the set value described in Embodiment 18 is one of effective values. However, not limited to this, α may be set, for example, for each value of i in the precoding matrix F[i] as described in Embodiment 17. (That is to say, in F[i], α is not necessarily be always set to a constant value for i.)
In the present embodiment, as one example of the case where λ is treated as a fixed value, a case where λ=0 radians is described. However, in view of the mapping according to the modulation scheme, λ may be set to a fixed value defined as λ=π/2 radians, λ=π radians, or λ=(3π)/2 radians. (For example, λ may be set to a fixed value defined as λ=π radians in the precoding matrices of the precoding scheme in which hopping between precoding matrices is performed regularly.) With this structure, as is the case where λ is set to a value defined as λ=0 radians, a reduction in circuit size is achieved.
The present embodiment describes an example of the precoding scheme of Embodiment 18 in which hopping between precoding matrices is performed regularly.
As an example of the precoding matrices prepared for the N slots based on Equation 269, the following matrices are considered:
In the above equations, there is a special case where α can be set to 1. In this case, Equations 339 through 347 are represented as follows.
As another example, as an example of the precoding matrices prepared for the N slots based on Equation 269, the following matrices are considered when N=15:
In the above equations, there is a special case where α can be set to 1. In this case, Equations 357 through 371 are represented as follows.
In the present example, α is set to 1. However, the value to which α is set is not limited to this. For example, the set value of α may be applied to the following case. That is to say, as shown in
As another example, as described in Embodiment 17, α may be set for each value of i in the precoding matrix F[i]. (That is to say, in F[i], α is not necessarily be always set to a constant value for i.)
In the present embodiment, the scheme of structuring N different precoding matrices for a precoding hopping scheme with an N-slot time period (cycle) has been described. In this case, as the N different precoding matrices, F[0], F[1], F[2], . . . , F[N−2], F[N−1] are prepared. In the single carrier transmission scheme, symbols are arranged in the order F[0], F[1], F[2], . . . , F[N−2], F[N−1] in the time domain (or the frequency domain in the case of the multi-carrier transmission scheme). The present invention is not, however, limited in this way, and the N different precoding matrices F[0], F[1], F[2], . . . , F[N−2], F[N−1] generated in the present embodiment may be adapted to a multi-carrier transmission scheme such as an OFDM transmission scheme or the like. As in Embodiment 1, as a scheme of adaptation in this case, precoding weights may be changed by arranging symbols in the frequency domain and in the frequency-time domain. Note that a precoding hopping scheme with an N-slot time period (cycle) has been described, but the same advantageous effects may be obtained by randomly using N different precoding matrices. In other words, the N different precoding matrices do not necessarily need to be used in a regular period (cycle).
The present embodiment describes an example of the precoding scheme of Embodiment 19 in which hopping between precoding matrices is performed regularly.
As an example of the precoding matrices prepared for the 2N slots based on Equations 279 and 280, the following matrices are considered when N=9:
In the above equations, there is a special case where a can be set to 1. In this case, Equations 387 through 404 are represented as follows.
Also, α may be set to 1 in Equations 281 through 310 presented in Embodiment 19. As the value to which α is set, the above-described set value is one of effective values. However, not limited to this, α may be set, for example, for each value of i in the precoding matrix F[i] as described in Embodiment 17. (That is to say, in F[i], a is not necessarily be always set to a constant value for i.)
In the present embodiment, the scheme of structuring 2N different precoding matrices for a precoding hopping scheme with a 2N-slot time period (cycle) has been described. In this case, as the 2N different precoding matrices, F[0], F[1], F[2], . . . , F[2N−2], F[2N−1] are prepared. In the single carrier transmission scheme, symbols are arranged in the order F[0], F[1], F[2], . . . , F[2N−2], F[2N−1] in the time domain (or the frequency domain in the case of the multi-carrier transmission scheme). The present invention is not, however, limited in this way, and the 2N different precoding matrices F[0], F[1], F[2], . . . , F[2N−2], F[2N−1] generated in the present embodiment may be adapted to a multi-carrier transmission scheme such as an OFDM transmission scheme or the like. As in Embodiment 1, as a scheme of adaptation in this case, precoding weights may be changed by arranging symbols in the frequency domain and in the frequency-time domain. Note that a precoding hopping scheme with a 2N-slot time period (cycle) has been described, but the same advantageous effects may be obtained by randomly using 2N different precoding matrices. In other words, the 2N different precoding matrices do not necessarily need to be used in a regular period (cycle).
Furthermore, in the precoding matrix hopping scheme over an H-slot period (cycle) (H being a natural number larger than the number of slots 2N in the period (cycle) of the above scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices), when the 2N different precoding matrices of the present embodiment are included, the probability of excellent reception quality increases.
In Embodiment 9, a scheme for regularly hopping between precoding matrices with use of a unitary matrix has been described. In the present embodiment, a scheme for regularly hopping between precoding matrices with use of a matrix different from that in Embodiment 9 is described.
First, a precoding matrix F, a basic precoding matrix, is expressed by the following equation.
In Equation 423, A, B, and C are real numbers, μ11, μ12, and μ21 are real numbers, and the units of them are radians. In the scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices over a period (cycle) with N slots, the precoding matrices prepared for the N slots are represented as follows.
In this case, i=0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1. Also, A, B, and C are fixed values regardless of i, and μ11, μ12, and μ21 are fixed values regardless of i. If a matrix represented by the format of Equation 424 is treated as a precoding matrix, “0” is present as one element of the precoding matrix, thus it has an advantageous effect that the poor reception points described in other embodiments can be reduced.
Also, another basic precoding matrix different from that expressed by Equation 423 is expressed by the following equation.
In Equation 425, A, B, and C are real numbers, μ11, μ12, and μ22 are real numbers, and the units of them are radians. In the scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices over a period (cycle) with N slots, the precoding matrices prepared for the N slots are represented as follows.
In this case, i=0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1. Also, A, B, and D are fixed values regardless of i, and μ11, μ12, and μ22 are fixed values regardless of i. If a matrix represented by the format of Equation 426 is treated as a precoding matrix, “0” is present as one element of the precoding matrix, thus it has an advantageous effect that the poor reception points described in other embodiments can be reduced.
Also, another basic precoding matrix different from those expressed by Equations 423 and 425 is expressed by the following equation.
In Equation 427, A, C, and D are real numbers, μ11, μ21, and μ22 are real numbers, and the units of them are radians. In the scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices over a period (cycle) with N slots, the precoding matrices prepared for the N slots are represented as follows.
In this case, i=0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1. Also, A, C, and D are fixed values regardless of i, and μ11, μ21, and μ22 are fixed values regardless of i. If a matrix represented by the format of Equation 428 is treated as a precoding matrix, “0” is present as one element of the precoding matrix, thus it has an advantageous effect that the poor reception points described in other embodiments can be reduced.
Also, another basic precoding matrix different from those expressed by Equations 423, 425, and 427 is expressed by the following equation.
In Equation 429, B, C, and D are real numbers, μ11, μ21, and μ22 are real numbers, and the units of them are radians. In the scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices over a period (cycle) with N slots, the precoding matrices prepared for the N slots are represented as follows.
In this case, i=0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1. Also, B, C, and D are fixed values regardless of i, and μ12, μ21, and μ22 are fixed values regardless of i. If a matrix represented by the format of Equation 430 is treated as a precoding matrix, “0” is present as one element of the precoding matrix, thus it has an advantageous effect that the poor reception points described in other embodiments can be reduced. From Condition #5 (Math 106) and Condition #6 (Math 107) in Embodiment 3, the following conditions are important for achieving excellent data reception quality.
Math 497
ej(θ
(x is 0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1; y is 0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1; and x≠y.)
Math 498
ej(θ
(x is 0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1; y is 0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1; and x≠y.)
In order to distribute the poor reception points evenly with regards to phase in the complex plane, as described in Embodiment 6, Condition #71 and Condition #72 are provided.
With this structure, the reception device can avoid poor reception points in the LOS environment, and thus can obtain the advantageous effect of improving the data reception quality.
Note that, as an example of the above-described scheme for regularly hopping between precoding matrices, there is a scheme for fixing θ11(i) to 0 radians (θ11(i) is set to a constant value regardless of i. In this case, θ11(i) may be set to a value other than 0 radians.) so that θ11(i) and θ21(i) satisfy the above-described conditions. Also, there is a scheme for not fixing θ11(i) to 0 radians, but fixing θ21(i) to 0 radians (θ21(i) is set to a constant value regardless of i. In this case, θ21(i) may be set to a value other than 0 radians.) so that θ11(i) and θ21(i) satisfy the above-described conditions.
The present embodiment describes the scheme of structuring N different precoding matrices for a precoding hopping scheme with an N-slot time period (cycle). In this case, as the N different precoding matrices, F[0], F[1], F[2], . . . , F[N−2], F[N−1] are prepared. In a single carrier transmission scheme, symbols are arranged in the order F[0], F[1], F[2], . . . , F[N−2], F[N−1] in the time domain (or the frequency domain in the case of multi-carrier transmission scheme). However, this is not the only example, and the N different precoding matrices F[0], F[1], F[2], . . . , F[N−2], F[N−1] generated according to the present embodiment may be adapted to a multi-carrier transmission scheme such as an OFDM transmission scheme or the like. As in Embodiment 1, as a scheme of adaption in this case, precoding weights may be changed by arranging symbols in the frequency domain or in the frequency-time domains. Note that a precoding hopping scheme with an N-slot time period (cycle) has been described, but the same advantageous effects may be obtained by randomly using N different precoding matrices. In other words, the N different precoding matrices do not necessarily need to be used in a regular period (cycle).
Furthermore, in the precoding matrix hopping scheme over an H-slot period (cycle) (H being a natural number larger than the number of slots N in the period (cycle) of the above scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices), when the N different precoding matrices of the present embodiment are included, the probability of excellent reception quality increases. In this case, Condition #69 and Condition #70 can be replaced by the following conditions. (The number of slots in the period (cycle) is considered to be N.)
Math 501
ej(θ
(x is 0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1; y is 0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1; and x≠y.)
Math 502
ej(θ
(x is 0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1; y is 0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1; and x≠y.)
In Embodiment 10, the scheme for regularly hopping between precoding matrices using a unitary matrix is described. However, the present embodiment describes a scheme for regularly hopping between precoding matrices using a matrix different from that used in Embodiment 10.
In the scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices over a period (cycle) with 2N slots, the precoding matrices prepared for the 2N slots are represented as follows.
Here, let A, B, and C be real numbers, and μ11, μ12, and μ21 be real numbers expressed in radians. In addition, A, B, and C are fixed values not depending on i. Similarly, μ11, μ12, and μ21 are fixed values not depending on i.
Here, let α, β, and δ be real numbers, and ν11, ν12, and ν22 be real numbers expressed in radians. In addition, α, β, and δ are fixed values not depending on i. Similarly, ν11, ν12, and ν22 are fixed values not depending on i.
The precoding matrices prepared for the 2N slots different from those in Equations 431 and 432 are represented by the following equations.
Here, let A, B, and C be real numbers, and ν11, ν12, and ν22 be real numbers expressed in radians. In addition, A, B, and C are fixed values not depending on i. Similarly, ν11, ν12, and ν22 are fixed values not depending on i.
Here, let β, γ, and δ be real numbers, and ν12, ν21, and ν22 be real numbers expressed in radians. In addition, β, γ, and δ are fixed values not depending on i. Similarly, ν12, ν21, and ν22 are fixed values not depending on i.
The precoding matrices prepared for the 2N slots different from those described above are represented by the following equations.
Here, let A, C, and D be real numbers, and ν11, ν21, and ν22 be real numbers expressed in radians. In addition, A, C, and D are fixed values not depending on i. Similarly, ν11, ν21, and ν22 are fixed values not depending on i.
Here, let α, β, and δ be real numbers, and ν11, ν12, and ν22 be real numbers expressed in radians. In addition, α, β, and δ are fixed values not depending on i. Similarly, ν11, ν12, and ν22 are fixed values not depending on i.
The precoding matrices prepared for the 2N slots different from those described above are represented by the following equations.
Here, let A, C, and D be real numbers, and ν11, ν21, and ν22 be real numbers expressed in radians. In addition, A, C, and D are fixed values not depending on i. Similarly, ν11, ν21, and ν22 are fixed values not depending on i.
Here, let β, γ, and δ be real numbers, and ν12, ν21, and ν22 be real numbers expressed in radians. In addition, β, γ, and δ are fixed values not depending on i. Similarly, ν12, ν21, and ν22 are fixed values not depending on i.
Making the same considerations as in Condition #5 (Math 106) and Condition #6 (Math 107) of Embodiment 3, the following conditions are important for achieving excellent data reception quality.
Math 511
Condition #75
ej(θ
(x is 0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1; y is 0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1; and x≠y.)
Math 512
ej(ψ
(x is N, N+1, N+2, . . . , 2N−2, 2N−1; y is N, N+1, N+2, . . . , 2N−2, 2N−1; and x≠y.)
Next, in order to distribute the poor reception points evenly with regards to phase in the complex plane, as described in Embodiment 6, Condition #77 or Condition #78 is provided.
Similarly, in order to distribute the poor reception points evenly with regards to phase in the complex plane, Condition #79 or Condition #80 is provided.
The above arrangement ensures to reduce the number of poor reception points described in the other embodiments because one of the elements of precoding matrices is “0”. In addition, the reception device is enabled to improve reception quality because poor reception points are effectively avoided especially in an LOS environment.
In an alternative scheme to the above-described precoding scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices, θ11(i) is fixed, for example, to 0 radians (a fixed value not depending on i, and a value other than 0 radians may be applicable) and θ11(i) and θ21(i) satisfy the conditions described above. In another alternative scheme, θ21(i) instead of θ11(i) is fixed, for example, to 0 radians (a fixed value not depending on i, and a value other than 0 radians may be applicable) and θ11(i) and θ21(i) satisfy the conditions described above.
Similarly, in another alternative scheme, Ψ11(i) is fixed, for example, to 0 radians (a fixed value not depending on i, and a value other than 0 radians may be applicable) and Ψ11(i) and Ψ21(i) satisfy the conditions described above. Similarly, in another alternative scheme, Ψ21(i) instead of Ψ11(i) is fixed, for example, to 0 radians (a fixed value not depending on i, and a value other than 0 radians may be applicable) and Ψ11(i) and Ψ21(i) satisfy the conditions described above.
The present embodiment describes the scheme of structuring 2N different precoding matrices for a precoding hopping scheme with a 2N-slot time period (cycle). In this case, as the 2N different precoding matrices, F[0], F[1], F[2], . . . , F[2N−2], F[2N−1] are prepared. In a single carrier transmission scheme, symbols are arranged in the order F[0], F[1], F[2], . . . , F[2N−2], F[2N−1] in the time domain (or the frequency domain in the case of multi-carrier). However, this is not the only example, and the 2N different precoding matrices F[0], F[1], F[2], . . . , F[2N−2], F[2N−1] generated in the present embodiment may be adapted to a multi-carrier transmission scheme such as an OFDM transmission scheme or the like. As in Embodiment 1, as a scheme of adaption in this case, precoding weights may be changed by arranging symbols in the frequency domain or in the frequency-time domain. Note that a precoding hopping scheme with a 2N-slot time period (cycle) has been described, but the same advantageous effects may be obtained by randomly using 2N different precoding matrices. In other words, the 2N different precoding matrices do not necessarily need to be used in a regular period (cycle).
Furthermore, in the precoding matrix hopping scheme over an H-slot period (cycle) (H being a natural number larger than the number of slots 2N in the period (cycle) of the above scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices), when the 2N different precoding matrices of the present embodiment are included, the probability of excellent reception quality increases.
The present embodiment describes a scheme for increasing the period (cycle) size of precoding hops between the precoding matrices, by applying Embodiment 17 to the precoding matrices described in Embodiment 23.
As described in Embodiment 23, in the scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices over a period (cycle) with N slots, the precoding matrices prepared for the N slots are represented as follows.
Here, i=0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1. In addition, A, B, and C are fixed values not depending on i. Similarly, μ11, μ12, and μ21 are fixed values not depending on i. Furthermore, the N×M period (cycle) precoding matrices based on Equation 439 are represented by the following equation.
Here, i=0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1, and k=0, 1, . . . , M−2, M−1. Precoding matrices F[0] to F[N×M−1] are thus generated (the precoding matrices F[0] to F[N×M−1] may be in any order for the N×M slots in the period (cycle)). Symbol number N×M×i may be precoded using F[0], symbol number N×M×i+1 may be precoded using F[1], . . . , and symbol number N×M×i+h may be precoded using F[h], for example (h=0, 1, 2, . . . , N×M−2, N×M−1). (In this case, as described in previous embodiments, precoding matrices need not be hopped between regularly.)
Generating the precoding matrices in this way achieves a precoding matrix hopping scheme with a large period (cycle), allowing for the position of poor reception points to be easily changed, which may lead to improved data reception quality. Note that while the N×M period (cycle) precoding matrices have been set to Equation 440, the N×M period (cycle) precoding matrices may be set to the following equation, as described above.
Here, i=0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1, and k=0, 1, . . . , M−2, M−1.
As described in Embodiment 23, in the scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices over a period (cycle) with N slots that is different from the above-described N slots, the precoding matrices prepared for the N slots are represented as follows.
Here, i=0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1. In addition, A, B, and D are fixed values not depending on i. Similarly, μ11, μ12, and μ22 are fixed values not depending on i. Furthermore, the N×M period (cycle) precoding matrices based on Equation 441 are represented by the following equation.
Here, i=0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1, and k=0, 1, . . . , M−2, M−1.
Precoding matrices F[0] to F[N×M−1] are thus generated (the precoding matrices F[0] to F[N×M−1] may be in any order for the N×M slots in the period (cycle)). Symbol number N×M×i may be precoded using F[0], symbol number N+1 may be precoded using F[1], . . . , and symbol number N×M×i+h may be precoded using F[h], for example (h=0, 1, 2, . . . , N×M−2, N×M−1). (In this case, as described in previous embodiments, precoding matrices need not be hopped between regularly.)
Generating the precoding matrices in this way achieves a precoding matrix hopping scheme with a large period (cycle), allowing for the position of poor reception points to be easily changed, which may lead to improved data reception quality. Note that while the N×M period (cycle) precoding matrices have been set to Equation 443, the N×M period (cycle) precoding matrices may be set to the following equation, as described above.
Here, i=0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1, and k=0, 1, . . . , M−2, M−1.
As described in Embodiment 23, in the scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices over a period (cycle) with N slots that is different from the above-described N slots, the precoding matrices prepared for the N slots are represented as follows.
Here, i=0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1. In addition, A, C, and D are fixed values not depending on i. Similarly, μ11, μ21, and μ22 are fixed values not depending on i. Furthermore, the N×M period (cycle) precoding matrices based on Equation 445 are represented by the following equation.
Here, i=0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1, and k=0, 1, . . . , M−2, M−1.
Precoding matrices F[0] to F[N×M−1] are thus generated (the precoding matrices F[0] to F[N×M−1] may be in any order for the N×M slots in the period (cycle)). Symbol number N×M×i may be precoded using F[0], symbol number N+1 may be precoded using F[1], . . . , and symbol number N×M×i+h may be precoded using F[h], for example (h=0, 1, 2, . . . , N×M−2, N×M−1). (In this case, as described in previous embodiments, precoding matrices need not be hopped between regularly.)
Generating the precoding matrices in this way achieves a precoding matrix hopping scheme with a large period (cycle), allowing for the position of poor reception points to be easily changed, which may lead to improved data reception quality. Note that while the N×M period (cycle) precoding matrices have been set to Equation 446, the N×M period (cycle) precoding matrices may be set to the following equation, as described above.
Here, i=0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1, and k=0, 1, . . . , M−2, M−1.
As described in Embodiment 23, in the scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices over a period (cycle) with N slots that is different from the above-described N slots, the precoding matrices prepared for the N slots are represented as follows.
Here, i=0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1. In addition, B, C, and D are fixed values not depending on i. Similarly, μ12, μ21, and μ22 are fixed values not depending on i. Furthermore, the N×M period (cycle) precoding matrices based on Equation 448 are represented by the following equation.
Here, i=0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1, and k=0, 1, . . . , M−2, M−1.
Precoding matrices F[0] to F[N×M−1] are thus generated (the precoding matrices F[0] to F[N×M−1] may be in any order for the N×M slots in the period (cycle)). Symbol number N×M×i may be precoded using F[0], symbol number N+1 may be precoded using F[1], . . . , and symbol number N×M×i+h may be precoded using F[h], for example (h=0, 1, 2, . . . , N×M−2, N×M−1). (In this case, as described in previous embodiments, precoding matrices need not be hopped between regularly.)
Generating the precoding matrices in this way achieves a precoding matrix hopping scheme with a large period (cycle), allowing for the position of poor reception points to be easily changed, which may lead to improved data reception quality. Note that while the N×M period (cycle) precoding matrices have been set to Equation 449, the N×M period (cycle) precoding matrices may be set to the following equation, as described above.
Here, i=0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1, and k=0, 1, . . . , M−2, M−1.
The present embodiment describes the scheme of structuring N×M different precoding matrices for a precoding hopping scheme with N×M slots in the time period (cycle). In this case, as the N×M different precoding matrices, F[0], F[1], F[2], . . . , F[N×M−2], F[N×M−1] are prepared. In a single carrier transmission scheme, symbols are arranged in the order F[0], F[1], F[2], . . . , F[N×M−2], F[N×M−1] in the time domain (or the frequency domain in the case of multi-carrier). However, this is not the only example, and the N×M different precoding matrices F[0], F[1], F[2], . . . , F[N×M−2], F[N×M−1] generated in the present embodiment may be adapted to a multi-carrier transmission scheme such as an OFDM transmission scheme or the like.
As in Embodiment 1, as a scheme of adaption in this case, precoding weights may be changed by arranging symbols in the frequency domain or in the frequency-time domain. Note that a precoding hopping scheme with N×M slots in the time period (cycle) has been described, but the same advantageous effects may be obtained by randomly using N×M different precoding matrices. In other words, the N×M different precoding matrices do not necessarily need to be used in a regular period (cycle).
Furthermore, in the precoding matrix hopping scheme over an H-slot period (cycle) (H being a natural number larger than the number of slots N×M in the period (cycle) of the above scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices), when the N×M different precoding matrices of the present embodiment are included, the probability of excellent reception quality increases.
The present embodiment describes a scheme for increasing the period (cycle) size of precoding hops between the precoding matrices, by applying Embodiment 20 to the precoding matrices described in Embodiment 24.
In the scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices over a period (cycle) with 2N slots, the precoding matrices prepared for the 2N slots are represented as follows.
Here, let A, B, and C be real numbers, and μ11, μ12, and μ21 be real numbers expressed in radians. In addition, A, B, and C are fixed values not depending on i. Similarly, μ11,μ12, and μ21 are fixed values not depending on i.
Here, let α, β, and δ be real numbers, and ν11, ν12, and ν22 be real numbers expressed in radians. In addition, α, β, and δ are fixed values not depending on i. Similarly, ν11, ν12, and ν22 are fixed values not depending on i. Furthermore, the 2×N×M period (cycle) precoding matrices based on Equations 451 and 452 are represented by the following equation.
Here, k=0, 1, . . . , M−2, M−1.
Here, k=0, 1, . . . , M−2, M−1. In addition, Xk=Yk may be true or Xk≠Yk may be true.
Precoding matrices F[0] to F[2×N×M−1] are thus generated (the precoding matrices F[0] to F[2×N×M−1] may be in any order for the 2×N×M slots in the period (cycle)). Symbol number 2×N×M×i may be precoded using F[0], symbol number 2×N×M×i+1 may be precoded using F[1], . . . , and symbol number 2×N×i+h may be precoded using F[h], for example (h=0, 1, 2, . . . , 2×N×M−2, 2×N×M−1). (In this case, as described in previous embodiments, precoding matrices need not be hopped between regularly.)
Generating the precoding matrices in this way achieves a precoding matrix hopping scheme with a large period (cycle), allowing for the position of poor reception points to be easily changed, which may lead to improved data reception quality.
The 2×N×M period (cycle) precoding matrices in Equation 453 may be changed to the following equation.
Here, k=0, 1, . . . , M−2, M−1.
The 2×N×M period (cycle) precoding matrices in Equation 454 may be changed to the following equation.
Here, k=0, 1, . . . , M−2, M−1.
Another example is shown below. In the scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices over a period (cycle) with 2N slots, the precoding matrices prepared for the 2N slots are represented as follows.
Here, let A, B, and C be real numbers, and μ11, μ12, and μ21 be real numbers expressed in radians. In addition, A, B, and C are fixed values not depending on i. Similarly, μ11, μ12, and μ21 are fixed values not depending on i.
Here, let β, γ, and δ be real numbers, and ν12, ν21, and ν22 be real numbers expressed in radians. In addition, β, γ, and δ are fixed values not depending on i. Similarly, ν12, ν21, and ν22 are fixed values not depending on i. Furthermore, the 2×N×M period (cycle) precoding matrices based on Equations 457 and 458 are represented by the following equation.
Here, k=0, 1, . . . , M−2, M−1.
Here, k=0, 1, . . . , M−2, M−1. Furthermore, Xk=Yk may be true, or Xk≠Yk may be true.
Precoding matrices F[0] to F[2×N×M−1] are thus generated (the precoding matrices F[0] to F[2×N×M−1] may be in any order for the 2×N×M slots in the period (cycle)). Symbol number 2×N×M×i may be precoded using F[0], symbol number 2×N×M×i+1 may be precoded using F[1], . . . , and symbol number 2×N×M×i+h may be precoded using F[h], for example (h=0, 1, 2, . . . , 2×N×M−2, 2×N×M−1). (In this case, as described in previous embodiments, precoding matrices need not be hopped between regularly.)
Generating the precoding matrices in this way achieves a precoding matrix hopping scheme with a large period (cycle), allowing for the position of poor reception points to be easily changed, which may lead to improved data reception quality.
The 2×N×M period (cycle) precoding matrices in Equation 459 may be changed to the following equation.
Here, k=0, 1, . . . , M−2, M−1.
The 2×N×M period (cycle) precoding matrices in Equation 460 may be changed to the following equation.
Here, k=0, 1, . . . , M−2, M−1.
Another example is shown below. In the scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices over a period (cycle) with 2N slots, the precoding matrices prepared for the 2N slots are represented as follows.
Here, let A, C, and D be real numbers, and μ11, μ21, and μ22 be real numbers expressed in radians. In addition, A, C, and D are fixed values not depending on i. Similarly, μ11, μ21, and μ22 are fixed values not depending on i.
Here, let α, β, and δ be real numbers, and ν11, ν12, and ν22 be real numbers expressed in radians. In addition, α, β, and δ are fixed values not depending on i. Similarly, ν11, ν12, and ν22 are fixed values not depending on i. Furthermore, the 2×N×M period (cycle) precoding matrices based on Equations 463 and 464 are represented by the following equation.
Here, k=0, 1, . . . , M−2, M−1.
Here, k=0, 1, . . . , M−2, M−1. Furthermore, Xk=Yk may be true, or Xk≠Yk may be true.
Precoding matrices F[0] to F[2×N×M−1] are thus generated (the precoding matrices F[0] to F[2×N×M−1] may be in any order for the 2×N×M slots in the period (cycle)). Symbol number 2×N×M×i may be precoded using F[0], symbol number 2×N×M×i+1 may be precoded using F[1], . . . , and symbol number 2×N×M×i+h may be precoded using F[h], for example (h=0, 1, 2, . . . , 2×N×M−2, 2×N×M−1). (In this case, as described in previous embodiments, precoding matrices need not be hopped between regularly.)
Generating the precoding matrices in this way achieves a precoding matrix hopping scheme with a large period (cycle), allowing for the position of poor reception points to be easily changed, which may lead to improved data reception quality.
The 2×N×M period (cycle) precoding matrices in Equation 465 may be changed to the following equation.
Here, k=0, 1, . . . , M−2, M−1.
The 2×N×M period (cycle) precoding matrices in Equation 466 may be changed to the following equation.
Here, k=0, 1, . . . , M−2, M−1.
Another example is shown below. In the scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices over a period (cycle) with 2N slots, the precoding matrices prepared for the 2N slots are represented as follows.
Here, let A, C, and D be real numbers, and μ11, μ21, and μ22 be real numbers expressed in radians. In addition, A, C, and D are fixed values not depending on i. Similarly, μ11, μ21, and μ22 are fixed values not depending on i.
Here, let β, γ, and δ be real numbers, and ν12, ν21, and ν22 be real numbers expressed in radians. In addition, β, γ, and δ are fixed values not depending on i. Similarly, ν12, ν21, and ν22 are fixed values not depending on i. Furthermore, the 2×N×M period (cycle) precoding matrices based on Equations 469 and 470 are represented by the following equation.
Here, k=0, 1, . . . , M−2, M−1.
Here, k=0, 1, . . . , M−2, M−1. Furthermore, Xk=Yk may be true, or Xk≠Yk may be true.
Precoding matrices F[0] to F[2×N×M−1] are thus generated (the precoding matrices F[0] to F[2×N×M−1] may be in any order for the 2×N××M slots in the period (cycle)). Symbol number 2×N×M×i may be precoded using F[0], symbol number 2×N×M×i+1 may be precoded using F[1], . . . , and symbol number 2×N×M×i+h may be precoded using F[h], for example (h=0, 1, 2, . . . , 2×N×M−2, 2×N×M−1). (In this case, as described in previous embodiments, precoding matrices need not be hopped between regularly.)
Generating the precoding matrices in this way achieves a precoding matrix hopping scheme with a large period (cycle), allowing for the position of poor reception points to be easily changed, which may lead to improved data reception quality.
The 2×N××M period (cycle) precoding matrices in Equation 471 may be changed to the following equation.
Here, k=0, 1, . . . , M−2, M−1.
The 2×N×M period (cycle) precoding matrices in Equation 472 may be changed to the following equation.
Here, k=0, 1, . . . , M−2, M−1.
Focusing on poor reception points in the above examples, the following conditions are important.
Math 553
ej(θ
(x is 0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1; y is 0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1; and x≠y.)
Math 554
ej(ψ
(x is N, N+1, N+2, . . . , 2N−2, 2N−1; y is N, N+1, N+2, . . . 2N−2, 2N−1; and x≠y)
Math 555
θ11(x)=θ11(x+N) for ∀x(x=0,1,2, . . . ,N−2,N−1)
and
θ21(y)=θ21(y+N) for ∀y(y=0,1,2, . . . ,N−2,N−1) Condition #83
Math 556
ψ11(x)=ψ11(x+N) for ∀x(x=0,1,2, . . . ,N−2,N−1)
and
ψ21(y)=ψ21(y+N) for ∀y(y=0,1,2, . . . ,N−2,N−1) Condition #66
By satisfying the conditions shown above, excellent data reception quality is achieved. Furthermore, the following conditions should be satisfied (See Embodiment 24).
Math 557
ej(θ
(x is 0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1; y is 0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1; and x≠y.)
Math 558
ej(ψ
(x is N, N+1, N+2, . . . , 2N−2, 2N−1; y is N, N+1, N+2, . . . , 2N−2, 2N−1; and x≠y.)
Focusing on Xk and Yk, the following conditions are noted.
Math 559
Xa≠Xb+2×s×π for ∀a,∀b(a≠b;a,b=0,1,2, . . . ,M−2,M−1) Condition #87
(a is 0, 1, 2, . . . , M−2, M−1; b is 0, 1, 2, . . . , M−2, M−1; and a≠b.)
Here, s is an integer.
Math 560
Ya≠Yb+2×u×π for ∀a,∀b(a≠b;a,b=0,1,2, . . . ,M−2,M−1) Condition #88
(a is 0, 1, 2, . . . , M−2, M−1; b is 0, 1, 2, . . . , M−2, M−1; and a≠b.)
(Here, u is an integer.)
By satisfying the two conditions shown above, excellent data reception quality is achieved. In Embodiment 25, Condition #87 should be satisfied.
The present embodiment describes the scheme of structuring 2×N×M different precoding matrices for a precoding hopping scheme with 2N×M slots in the time period (cycle). In this case, as the 2×N×M different precoding matrices, F[0], F[1], F[2], . . . , F[2×N×M−2], F[2×N×M−1] are prepared. In a single carrier transmission scheme, symbols are arranged in the order F[0], F[1], F[2], . . . , F[2×N×M−2], F[2×N×M−1] in the time domain (or the frequency domain in the case of multi-carrier). However, this is not the only example, and the 2×N×M different precoding matrices F[0], F[1], F[2], . . . , F[2×N×M−2], F[2×N×M−1] generated in the present embodiment may be adapted to a multi-carrier transmission scheme such as an OFDM transmission scheme or the like.
As in Embodiment 1, as a scheme of adaption in this case, precoding weights may be changed by arranging symbols in the frequency domain or in the frequency-time domain. Note that a precoding hopping scheme with 2×N×M slots the time period (cycle) has been described, but the same advantageous effects may be obtained by randomly using 2×N×M different precoding matrices. In other words, the 2×N××M different precoding matrices do not necessarily need to be used in a regular period (cycle).
Furthermore, in the precoding matrix hopping scheme over an H-slot period (cycle) (H being a natural number larger than the number of slots 2×N××M in the period (cycle) of the above scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices), when the 2×N××M different precoding matrices of the present embodiment are included, the probability of excellent reception quality increases.
In the present embodiment, a detailed description is given of a scheme for adapting the above-described transmission schemes that regularly hops between precoding matrices to a communications system compliant with the DVB (Digital Video Broadcasting)-T2 (T:Terrestrial) standard (DVB for a second generation digital terrestrial television broadcasting system).
The P1 Signalling data (6101) is a symbol for use by a reception device for signal detection and frequency synchronization (including frequency offset estimation). Also, the P1 Signalling data (6101) transmits information including information indicating the FFT (Fast Fourier Transform) size, and information indicating which of SISO (Single-Input Single-Output) and MISO (Multiple-Input Single-Output) is employed to transmit a modulated signal. (The SISO scheme is for transmitting one modulated signal, whereas the MISO scheme is for transmitting a plurality of modulated signals using space-time block coding.)
The L1 Pre-Signalling data (6102) transmits information including: information about the guard interval used in transmitted frames; information about PAPR (Peak to Average Power Ratio) method; information about the modulation scheme, error correction scheme (FEC: Forward Error Correction), and coding rate of the error correction scheme all used in transmitting L1 Post-Signalling data; information about the size of L1 Post-Signalling data and the information size; information about the pilot pattern; information about the cell (frequency region) unique number; and information indicating which of the normal mode and extended mode (the respective modes differs in the number of subcarriers used in data transmission) is used.
The L1 Post-Signalling data (6103) transmits information including: information about the number of PLPs; information about the frequency region used; information about the unique number of each PLP; information about the modulation scheme, error correction scheme, coding rate of the error correction scheme all used in transmitting the PLPs; and information about the number of blocks transmitted in each PLP.
The Common PLP (6104) and PLPs #1 to # N (6105_1 to 6105N) are fields used for transmitting data.
In the frame structure shown in
A P2 symbol signal generating unit 6305 receives P2 symbol transmission data 6304 and the control signal 6309 as input, performs mapping according to the error correction scheme and modulation scheme indicated for each P2 symbol by the information included in the control signal 6309, and outputs a (quadrature) baseband signal 6306 carrying the P2 symbols.
A control signal generating unit 6308 receives P1 symbol transmission data 6307 and P2 symbol transmission data 6304 as input, and then outputs, as the control signal 6309, information about the transmission scheme (the error correction scheme, coding rate of the error correction, modulation scheme, block length, frame structure, selected transmission schemes including a transmission scheme that regularly hops between precoding matrices, pilot symbol insertion scheme, IFFT (Inverse Fast Fourier Transform)/FFT, method of reducing PAPR, and guard interval insertion scheme) of each symbol group shown in
A frame structuring unit 6310 receives, as input, the baseband signal 6303 carrying PLPs, the baseband signal 6306 carrying P2 symbols, and the control signal 630. On receipt of the input, the frame structuring unit 6310 changes the order of input data in frequency domain and time domain based on the information about frame structure included in the control signal, and outputs a (quadrature) baseband signal 6311_1 corresponding to stream 1 and a (quadrature) baseband signal 6311_2 corresponding to stream 2 both in accordance with the frame structure.
A signal processing unit 6312 receives, as input, the baseband signal 6311_1 corresponding to stream 1, the baseband signal 6311_2 corresponding to stream 2, and the control signal 6309 and outputs a modulated signal 1 (6313_1) and a modulated signal 2(6313_2) each obtained as a result of signal processing based on the transmission scheme indicated by information included in the control signal 6309. The characteristic feature noted here lies in the following. That is, when a transmission scheme that regularly hops between precoding matrices is selected, the signal processing unit hops between precoding matrices and performs weighting (precoding) in a manner similar to
A pilot inserting unit 6314_1 receives, as input, the modulated signal 1 (6313_1) obtained as a result of the signal processing and the control signal 6309, inserts pilot symbols into the received modulated signal 1 (6313_1), and outputs a modulated signal 6315_1 obtained as a result of the pilot signal insertion. Note that the pilot symbol insertion is carried out based on information indicating the pilot symbol insertion scheme included the control signal 6309.
A pilot inserting unit 6314_2 receives, as input, the modulated signal 2 (6313_2) obtained as a result of the signal processing and the control signal 6309, inserts pilot symbols into the received modulated signal 2 (6313_2), and outputs a modulated signal 6315_2 obtained as a result of the pilot symbol insertion. Note that the pilot symbol insertion is carried out based on information indicating the pilot symbol insertion scheme included the control signal 6309.
An IFFT (Inverse Fast Fourier Transform) unit 6316_1 receives, as input, the modulated signal 6315_1 obtained as a result of the pilot symbol insertion and the control signal 6309, and applies IFFT based on the information about the IFFT method included in the control signal 6309, and outputs a signal 6317_1 obtained as a result of the IFFT.
An IFFT unit 6316_2 receives, as input, the modulated signal 6315_2 obtained as a result of the pilot symbol insertion and the control signal 6309, and applies IFFT based on the information about the IFFT method included in the control signal 6309, and outputs a signal 6317_2 obtained as a result of the IFFT.
A PAPR reducing unit 6318_1 receives, as input, the signal 6317_1 obtained as a result of the IFFT and the control signal 6309, performs processing to reduce PAPR on the received signal 6317_1, and outputs a signal 6319_1 obtained as a result of the PAPR reduction processing. Note that the PAPR reduction processing is performed based on the information about the PAPR reduction included in the control signal 6309.
A PAPR reducing unit 6318_2 receives, as input, the signal 6317_2 obtained as a result of the IFFT and the control signal 6309, performs processing to reduce PAPR on the received signal 6317_2, and outputs a signal 6319_2 obtained as a result of the PAPR reduction processing. Note that the PAPR reduction processing is carried out based on the information about the PAPR reduction included in the control signal 6309.
A guard interval inserting unit 6320_1 receives, as input, the signal 6319_1 obtained as a result of the PAPR reduction processing and the control signal 6309, inserts guard intervals into the received signal 6319_1, and outputs a signal 6321_1 obtained as a result of the guard interval insertion. Note that the guard interval insertion is carried out based on the information about the guard interval insertion scheme included in the control signal 6309.
A guard interval inserting unit 6320_2 receives, as input, the signal 6319_2 obtained as a result of the PAPR reduction processing and the control signal 6309, inserts guard intervals into the received signal 6319_2, and outputs a signal 6321_2 obtained as a result of the guard interval insertion. Note that the guard interval insertion is carried out based on the information about the guard interval insertion scheme included in the control signal 6309.
A P1 symbol inserting unit 6322 receives, as input, the signal 6321_1 obtained as a result of the guard interval insertion, the signal 6321_2 obtained as a result of the guard interval insertion, and the P1 symbol transmission data 6307, generates a P1 symbol signal from the P1 symbol transmission data 6307, adds the P1 symbol to the signal 6321_1 obtained as a result of the guard interval insertion, and adds the P1 symbol to the signal 6321_2 obtained as a result of the guard interval insertion. Then, the P1 symbol inserting unit 6322 outputs a signal 6323_1 obtained as a result of the processing related to P1 symbol and a signal 6323_2 obtained as a result of the processing related to P1 symbol. Note that a P1 symbol signal may be added to both the signals 6323_1 and 6323_2 or to one of the signals 6323_1 and 6323_2. In the case where the P1 symbol signal is added to one of the signals 6323_1 and 6323_2, the following is noted. For purposes of description, an interval of the signal to which α P1 symbol is added is referred to as a P1 symbol interval. Then, the signal to which α P1 signal is not added includes, as a baseband signal, a zero signal in an interval corresponding to the P1 symbol interval of the other signal. A wireless processing unit 6324_1 receives the signal 6323_1 obtained as a result of the processing related to P1 symbol, performs processing such as frequency conversion, amplification, and the like, and outputs a transmission signal 6325_1. The transmission signal 6325_1 is then output as a radio wave from an antenna 6326_1.
A wireless processing unit 6324_2 receives the signal 6323_2 obtained as a result of the processing related to P1 symbol, performs processing such as frequency conversion, amplification, and the like, and outputs a transmission signal 6325_2. The transmission signal 6325_2 is then output as a radio wave from an antenna 6326_2. Next, a detailed description is given of the frame structure of a transmission signal and the transmission scheme of control information (information carried by the P1 symbol and P2 symbols) employed by a broadcast station (base station) in the case where the scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices is adapted to a DVB-T2 system.
As shown in
In interval 2, a symbol group 6402 of PLP #2 is transmitted using stream s1, and the data transmission is carried out by transmitting one modulated signal.
In interval 3, a symbol group 6403 of PLP #3 is transmitted using streams s1 and s2, and the data transmission is carried out using a precoding scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices.
In interval 4, a symbol group 6404 of PLP #4 is transmitted using streams s1 and s2, and the data transmission is carried out using space-time block coding shown in
In the case where a broadcast station transmits PLPs in the frame structure shown in
Table 3 shows a specific example of control information transmitted using a P1 symbol.
According to the DVB-T2 standard, the control information S1 (three bits) enables the reception device to determine whether or not the DVB-T2 standard is used and also to determine, if DVB-T2 is used, which transmission scheme is used. If the three bits are set to “000”, the S1 information indicates that the modulated signal transmitted in accordance with “transmission of a modulated signal compliant with the DVB-T2 standard”.
If the three bits are set to “001”, the S1 information indicates that the modulated signal transmitted is in accordance with “transmission using space-time block coding compliant with the DVB-T2 standard”.
In the DVB-T2 standard, the bit sets “010” to “111” are “Reserved” for future use. In order to adapt the present invention in a manner to establish compatibility with the DVB-T2, the three bits constituting the S1 information may be set to “010” (or any bit set other than “000” and “001”) to indicate that the modulated signal transmitted is compliant with a standard other than DVB-T2. On determining that the S1 information received is set to “010”, the reception device is informed that the modulated signal transmitted from the broadcast station is compliant with a standard other than DVB-T2.
Next, a description is given of examples of the scheme of structuring a P2 symbol in the case where a modulated signal transmitted by the broadcast station is compliant with a standard other than DVB-T2. The first example is directed to a scheme in which P2 symbol compliant with the DVB-T2 standard is used.
Table 4 shows a first example of control information transmitted using L1 Post-Signalling data, which is one of P2 symbols.
SISO: Single-Input Single-Output (one modulated signal is transmitted and receive with one antenna)
SIMO: Single-Input Multiple-Output (one modulated signal is transmitted and received with a plurality of antennas)
MISO: Multiple-Input Single-Output (a plurality of modulated signals are transmitted from a plurality of antennas and received with one antenna)
MIMO: Multiple-Input Multiple-Output (a plurality of modulated signals are transmitted from a plurality of antennas and received with a plurality of antennas)
The 2-bit information “PLP_MODE” shown in Table 4 is control information used to indicate the transmission scheme used for each PLP as shown in
When the PLP_MODE is set to “00”, the data transmission by a corresponding PLP is carried out by “transmitting one modulated signal”. When the PLP_MODE is set to “01”, the data transmission by a corresponding PLP is carried out by “transmitting a plurality of modulated signals obtained by space-time block coding”. When the PLP_MODE is set to “10”, the data transmission by a corresponding PLP is carried out using a “precoding scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices”. When the PLP_MODE is set to “11”, the data transmission by a corresponding PLP is carried out using a “MIMO system with a fixed precoding matrix or spatial multiplexing MIMO system”.
Note that when the PLP_MODE is set to “01” to “11”, the information indicating the specific processing conducted by the broadcast station (for example, the specific hopping scheme used in the scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices, the specific space-time block coding scheme used, and the structure of precoding matrices used) needs to be notified to the terminal. The following describes the scheme of structuring control information that includes such information and that is different from the example shown in Table 4.
Table 5 shows a second example of control information transmitted using L1 Post-Signalling data, which is one of P2 symbols. The second example shown in Table 5 is different from the first example shown in Table 4.
As shown in Table 5, the control information includes “PLP_MODE” which is one bit long, “MIMO_MODE” which is one bit long, “MIMO_PATTERN #1” which is two bits long, and “MIMO_PATTERN #2” which is two bits long. As shown in
With the PLP_MODE set to “0”, the data transmission by a corresponding PLP is carried out by “transmitting one modulated signal”. With the PLP_MODE set to “1”, the data transmission by a corresponding PLP is carried out by “transmitting a plurality of modulated signals obtained by space-time block coding”, “precoding scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices”, “MIMO system with a fixed precoding matrix”, or “spatial multiplexing MIMO system”.
With the “PLP_MODE” set to “1”, the “MIMO_MODE” information is made effective. With “MIMO_MODE” set to “0”, data transmission is carried out by a scheme other than the “precoding scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices”. With “MIMO_MODE” set to “1”, on the other hand, data transmission is carried out by the “precoding scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices”.
With “PLP_MODE” set to “1” and “MIMO_MODE” set to “0”, the “MIMO_PATTERN #1” information is made effective. With “MIMO_PATTERN #1” set to “00”, data transmission is carried out using space-time block coding. With “MIMO_PATTERN” set to “01”, data transmission is carried out using a precoding scheme in which weighting is performed using a fixed precoding matrix #1. With “MIMO_PATTERN” set to “10”, data transmission is carried out using a precoding scheme in which weighting is performed using a fixed precoding matrix #2 (Note that the precoding matrix #1 and precoding matrix #2 are mutually different). When “MIMO_PATTERN” set to “11”, data transmission is carried out using spatial multiplexing MIMO system (Naturally, it may be construed that Scheme 1 shown in
With “PLP_MODE” set to “1” and “MIMO_MODE” set to “1”, the “MIMO_PATTERN #2” information is made effective. Then, with “MIMO_PATTERN #2” set to “00”, data transmission is carried out using the precoding matrix hopping scheme #1 according to which precoding matrices are regularly hopped. With “MIMO_PATTERN #2” set to “01”, data transmission is carried out using the precoding matrix hopping scheme #2 according to which precoding matrices are regularly hopped. With “MIMO_PATTERN #2” set to “10”, data transmission is carried out using the precoding matrix hopping scheme #3 according to which precoding matrices are regularly hopped. With “MIMO_PATTERN #2” set to “11”, data transmission is carried out using the precoding matrix hopping scheme #4 according to which precoding matrices are regularly hopped. Note that the precoding matrix hopping schemes #1 to #4 are mutually different. Here, to define a scheme being different, it is supposed that # A and # B are mutually different schemes and then one of the following is true.
In the above description, the control information shown in Tables 4 and 5 is transmitted on L1 Post-Signalling data, which is one of P2 symbols. According to the DVB-T2 standard, however, the amount of information that can be transmitted as P2 symbols is limited. Therefore, addition of information shown in Tables 4 and 5 to the information required in the DVB-T2 standard to be transmitted using P2 symbols may result in an amount exceeding the maximum amount that can be transmitted as P2 symbols. In such a case, Signalling PLP (6501) may be provided as shown in
As described above, the present embodiment allows for choice of a scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices while using a multi-carrier scheme, such as an OFDM scheme, without compromising the compatibility with the DVB-T2 standard. This offers the advantages of obtaining high reception quality, as well as high transmission speed, in an LOS environment. While in the present embodiment, the transmission schemes to which a carrier group can be set are “a spatial multiplexing MIMO system, a MIMO scheme using a fixed precoding matrix, a MIMO scheme for regularly hopping between precoding matrices, space-time block coding, or a transmission scheme for transmitting only stream s1”, but the transmission schemes are not limited in this way. Furthermore, the MIMO scheme using a fixed precoding matrix limited to scheme #2 in
Furthermore, the above description is directed to a scheme in which the schemes selectable by the broadcast station are “a spatial multiplexing MIMO system, a MIMO scheme using a fixed precoding matrix, a MIMO scheme for regularly hopping between precoding matrices, space-time block coding, or a transmission scheme for transmitting only stream s1”. However, it is not necessary that all of the transmission schemes are selectable. Any of the following examples is also possible.
Here, it is necessary to set the control information S1 in P1 symbols as described above. In addition, as P2 symbols, the control information may be set differently from a scheme (the scheme for setting the transmission scheme of each PLP) shown in Table 4. Table 6 shows one example of such a scheme.
Table 6 differs from Table 4 in that the “PLP_MODE” set to “11” is “Reserved.” In this way, the number of bits constituting the “PLP_MODE” shown in Tables 4 and 6 may be increased or decreased depending on the number of selectable PLP transmission schemes, in the case where the selectable transmission schemes are as shown in the above examples.
The same holds with respect to Table 5. For example, if the only MIMO scheme supported is a precoding scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices, the control information “MIMO_MODE” is no longer necessary. Furthermore, the control information “MIMO_PATTERN #1” may not be necessary in the case, for example, where a MIMO scheme using a fixed precoding matrix is not supported. Furthermore, the control information “MIMO_PATTERN #1” may be one bit long instead of two bits long, in the case where, for example, no more than one precoding matrix is required for a MIMO scheme using a fixed precoding matrix. Furthermore, the control information “MIMO_PATTERN #1” may be two bits long or more in the case where a plurality of precoding matrices are selectable.
The same applies to “MIMO_PATTERN #2”. That is, the control information “MIMO_PATTERN #2” may be one bit long instead of two bits long, in the case where no more than one precoding scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices is available. Alternatively, the control information “MIMO_PATTERN #2” may be two bits long or more in the case where a plurality of precoding schemes of regularly hopping between precoding matrices are selectable.
In the present embodiment, the description is directed to the transmission device having two antennas, but the number of antennas is not limited to two. With a transmission device having more than two antennas, the control information may be transmitted in the same manner. Yet, to enable the modulated signal transmission with the use of four antennas in addition to the modulated signal transmission with the use of two antennas, there may be a case where the number of bits constituting respective pieces of control information needs to be increased. In such a modification, it still holds that the control information is transmitted by the P1 symbol and the control information is transmitted by P2 symbols as set forth above.
The above description is directed to the frame structure of PLP symbol groups transmitted by a broadcast station in a time-sharing transmission scheme as shown in
In
For the sake of simplicity,
Therefore, data transmission by the symbol group 6701 of PLP #1 shown in
Alternatively, the symbol arrangement may be in the frequency domain or in symbol groups formed in the time and frequency domains. In addition, the space-time block coding is not limited to the one shown in
In
For the sake of simplicity,
As set forth above, no PLPs using “a transmission scheme for transmitting only stream s1” exist in the T2 frame, so that the dynamic range of a signal received by the terminal is ensured to be narrow. As a result, the advantageous effect is achieved that the probability of excellent reception quality increases.
Note that the description of
The above description relates to an example in which the T2 frame includes a plurality of PLPs. The following describes an example in which T2 frame includes one PLP only.
In the example shown in
In the second T2 frame, a symbol group 6802 for PLP #2-1 is transmitted and the transmission scheme selected is “a scheme for transmitting one modulated signal”.
In the third T2 frame, a symbol group 6803 for PLP #3-1 is transmitted and the transmission scheme selected is “a precoding scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices”.
In the fourth T2 frame, a symbol group 6804 for PLP #4-1 is transmitted and the transmission scheme selected is “space-time block coding”. Note that the symbol arrangement used in the space-time block coding is not limited to the arrangement in the time domain. Alternatively, the symbol arrangement may be in the frequency domain or in symbol groups formed in the time and frequency domains. In addition, the space-time block coding is not limited to the one shown in
In
In the above manner, a transmission scheme may be set for each PLP in consideration of the data transmission speed and the data reception quality at the receiving terminal, so that increase in data transmission seeped and excellent reception quality are both achieved. As an example scheme of structuring control information, the control information indicating, for example, the transmission scheme and other information of P1 symbol and P2 symbols (and also Signalling PLP where applicable) may be configured in a similar manner to Tables 3-6. The difference is as follows. In the frame structure shown, for example, in
Although the above description is directed to the scheme of transmitting information about the PLP transmission scheme using P1 symbol and P2 symbols (and Signalling PLPs where applicable), the following describes in particular the scheme of transmitting information about the PLP transmission scheme without using P2 symbols.
By the P1 Signalling data (6101), data indicating that the symbol is for a reception device to perform signal detection and frequency synchronization (including frequency offset estimation) is transmitted. In this example, in addition, data identifying whether or not the frame supports the DVB-T2 standard needs to be transmitted. For example, by S1 shown in Table 3, data indicating whether or not the signal supports the DVB-T2 standard needs to be transmitted.
By the first 1 Signalling data (7001), the following information may be transmitted for example: information about the guard interval used in the transmission frame; information about the method of PAPR (Peak to Average Power Ratio); information about the modulation scheme, error correction scheme, coding rate of the error correction scheme all of which are used in transmitting the second Signalling data; information about the size of the second Signalling data and about information size; information about the pilot pattern; information about the cell (frequency domain) unique number; and information indicating which of the norm mode and extended mode is used. Here, it is not necessary that the first Signalling data (7001) transmits data supporting the DVB-T2 standard. By L2 Post-Signalling data (7002), the following information may be transmitted for example: information about the number of PLPs; information about the frequency domain used; information about the unique number of each PLP; information about the modulation scheme, error correction scheme, coding rate of the error correction scheme all of which are used in transmitting the PLPs; and information about the number of blocks transmitted in each PLP.
In the frame structure shown in
The control signal generating unit 7202 receives the control signal 6309 and the transmission data 7201 for first and second Signalling data as input. The control signal generating unit 7202 then performs error correction coding and mapping based on the modulation scheme, according to the information carried in the control signal 6309 (namely, information about the error correction of the first and second Signalling data, information about the modulation scheme) and outputs a (quadrature) baseband signal 7203 of the first and second Signalling data.
Next, a detailed description is given of the frame structure of a transmission signal and the transmission scheme of control information (information carried by the P1 symbol and first and second 2 Signalling data) employed by a broadcast station (base station) in the case where the scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices is adapted to a system compliant with a standard other than the DVB-T2 standard.
As shown in
In interval 2, a symbol group 6402 of PLP #2 is transmitted using stream s1, and the data transmission is carried out by transmitting one modulated signal.
In interval 3, a symbol group 6403 of PLP #3 is transmitted using streams s1 and s2, and the data transmission is carried out using a precoding scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices.
In interval 4, a symbol group 6404 of PLP #4 is transmitted using streams s1 and s2, and the data transmission is carried out using the space-time block coding shown in
In the case where a broadcast station transmits PLPs in the frame structure shown in
According to the DVB-T2 standard, the control information S1 (three bits) enables the reception device to determine whether or not the DVB-T2 standard is used and also determine, if DVB-T2 is used, the transmission scheme used. If the three bits are set to “000”, the S1 information indicates that the modulated signal transmitted is in compliant with “transmission of a modulated signal compliant with the DVB-T2 standard”.
If the three bits are set to “001”, the S1 information indicates that the modulated signal transmitted is in compliant with “transmission using space-time block coding compliant with the DVB-T2 standard”.
In the DVB-T2 standard, the bit sets “010” to “111” are “Reserved” for future use. In order to adapt the present invention in a manner to establish compatibility with the DVB-T2, the three bits constituting the S1 information may be set to “010” (or any bit set other than “000” and “001”) to indicate that the modulated signal transmitted is compliant with a standard other than DVB-T2. On determining that the S1 information received is set to “010”, the reception device is informed that the modulated signal transmitted from the broadcast station is compliant with a standard other than DVB-T2.
Next, a description is given of examples of the scheme of structuring first and second Signalling data in the case where a modulated signal transmitted by the broadcast station is compliant with a standard other than DVB-T2. A first example of the control information for the first and second Signalling data is as shown in Table 4.
The 2-bit information “PLP_MODE” shown in Table 4 is control information used to indicate the transmission scheme used for each PLP as shown in
With the PLP_MODE set to “00”, the data transmission by a corresponding PLP is carried out by “transmitting one modulated signal”. When the PLP_MODE is set to “01”, the data transmission by a corresponding PLP is carried out by “transmitting a plurality of modulated signals obtained by space-time block coding”. When the PLP_MODE is set to “10”, the data transmission by a corresponding PLP is carried out using a “precoding scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices”. When the PLP_MODE is set to “11”, the data transmission by a corresponding PLP is carried out using a “MIMO system with a fixed precoding matrix or spatial multiplexing MIMO system”.
Note that when the PLP_MODE is set to “01” to “11”, the information indicating the specific processing conducted by the broadcast station (for example, the specific hopping scheme used in the scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices, the specific space-time block coding scheme used, and the structure of precoding matrices used) needs to be notified to the terminal. The following describes the scheme of structuring control information that includes such information and that is different from the example shown in Table 4.
A second example of the control information for the first and second Signalling data is as shown in Table 5.
As shown in Table 5, the control information includes “PLP_MODE” which is one bit long, “MIMO_MODE” which is one bit long, “MIMO_PATTERN #1” which is two bits long, and “MIMO_PATTERN #2” which is two bits long. As shown in
With the PLP_MODE set to “0”, the data transmission by a corresponding PLP is carried out by “transmitting one modulated signal”. With the PLP_MODE set to “1”, the data transmission by a corresponding PLP is carried out by “transmitting a plurality of modulated signals obtained by space-time block coding”, “precoding scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices”, “MIMO system with a fixed precoding matrix or spatial multiplexing MIMO system”, or “spatial multiplexing MIMO system”.
With the “PLP_MODE” set to “1”, the “MIMO_MODE” information is made effective. With “MIMO_MODE” set to “0”, data transmission is carried out by a scheme other than the “precoding scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices”. With “MIMO_MODE” set to “1”, on the other hand, data transmission is carried out by the “precoding scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices”.
With “PLP_MODE” set to “1” and “MIMO_MODE” set to “0”, the “MIMO_PATTERN #1” information is made effective. With “MIMO_PATTERN #1” set to “00”, data transmission is carried out using space-time block coding. With “MIMO_PATTERN” set to “01”, data transmission is carried out using a precoding scheme in which weighting is performed using a fixed precoding matrix #1. With “MIMO_PATTERN” set to “10”, data transmission is carried out using a precoding scheme in which weighting is performed using a fixed precoding matrix #2 (Note that the precoding matrix #1 and precoding matrix #2 are mutually different). When “MIMO_PATTERN” set to “11”, data transmission is carried out using spatial multiplexing MIMO system (Naturally, it may be construed that Scheme 1 shown in
With “PLP_MODE” set to “1” and “MIMO_MODE” set to “1”, the “MIMO_PATTERN #2” information is made effective. With “MIMO_PATTERN #2” set to “00”, data transmission is carried out using the precoding matrix hopping scheme #1 according to which precoding matrices are regularly hopped. With “MIMO_PATTERN #2” set to “01”, data transmission is carried out using the precoding matrix hopping scheme #2 according to which precoding matrices are regularly hopped. With “MIMO_PATTERN #3” set to “10”, data transmission is carried out using the precoding matrix hopping scheme #2 according to which precoding matrices are regularly hopped. With “MIMO_PATTERN #4” set to “11”, data transmission is carried out using the precoding matrix hopping scheme #2 according to which precoding matrices are regularly hopped. Note that the precoding matrix hopping schemes #1 to #4 are mutually different. Here, to define a scheme being different, it is supposed that # A and # B are mutually different schemes. Then one of the following is true.
In the above description, the control information shown in Tables 4 and 5 is transmitted by first and second Signalling data. In this case, the advantage of eliminating the need to specifically use PLPs to transmit control information is achieved.
As described above, the present embodiment allows for choice of a scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices while using a multi-carrier scheme, such as an OFDM scheme and while allowing a standard other than DVB-T2 to be distinguished from DVB-T2. This offers the advantages of obtaining high reception quality, as well as high transmission speed, in an LOS environment. While in the present embodiment, the transmission schemes to which α carrier group can be set are “a spatial multiplexing MIMO system, a MIMO scheme using a fixed precoding matrix, a MIMO scheme for regularly hopping between precoding matrices, space-time block coding, or a transmission scheme for transmitting only stream s1”, but the transmission schemes are not limited in this way. Furthermore, the MIMO scheme using a fixed precoding matrix limited to scheme #2 in
Furthermore, the above description is directed to a scheme in which the schemes selectable by the broadcast station are “a spatial multiplexing MIMO system, a MIMO scheme using a fixed precoding matrix, a MIMO scheme for regularly hopping between precoding matrices, space-time block coding, or a transmission scheme for transmitting only stream s1”. However, it is not necessary that all of the transmission schemes are selectable. Any of the following examples is also possible.
As listed above, as long as a MIMO scheme for regularly hopping between precoding matrices is included as a selectable scheme, the advantageous effects of high-speed data transmission is obtained in an LOS environment, in addition to excellent reception quality for the reception device.
Here, it is necessary to set the control information S1 in P1 symbols as described above. In addition, as first and second Signalling data, the control information may be set differently from a scheme (the scheme for setting the transmission scheme of each PLP) shown in Table 4. Table 6 shows one example of such a scheme.
Table 6 differs from Table 4 in that the “PLP_MODE” set to “11” is “Reserved” In this way, the number of bits constituting the “PLP_MODE” shown in Tables 4 and 6 may be increased or decreased depending on the number of selectable PLP transmission schemes, which varies as in the examples listed above.
The same holds with respect to Table 5. For example, if the only MIMO scheme supported is a precoding scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices, the control information “MIMO_MODE” is no longer necessary. Furthermore, the control information “MIMO_PATTERN #1” may not be necessary in the case, for example, where a MIMO scheme using a fixed precoding matrix is not supported. Furthermore, the control information “MIMO_PATTERN #1” may not necessarily be two bits long and may alternatively be one bit long in the case where, for example, no more than one precoding matrix is required for such a MIMO scheme using a fixed precoding matrix. Furthermore, the control information “MIMO_PATTERN #1” may be two bits long or more in the case where a plurality of precoding matrices are selectable.
The same applies to “MIMO_PATTERN #2”. That is, the control information “MIMO_PATTERN #2” may be one bit long instead of two bits long, in the case where no more than one precoding scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices is available. Alternatively, the control information “MIMO_PATTERN #2” may be two bits long or more in the case where a plurality of precoding schemes of regularly hopping between precoding matrices are selectable.
In the present embodiment, the description is directed to the transmission device having two antennas, but the number of antennas is not limited to two. With a transmission device having more than two antennas, the control information may be transmitted in the same manner. Yet, to enable the modulated signal transmission with the use of four antennas in addition to the modulated signal transmission with the use of two antennas may require that the number of bits constituting respective pieces of control information needs to be increased. In such a modification, it still holds that the control information is transmitted by the P1 symbol and the control information is transmitted by first and second Signalling data as set forth above.
The above description is directed to the frame structure of PLP symbol groups transmitted by a broadcast station in a time-sharing transmission scheme as shown in
In
In
For the sake of simplicity,
Therefore, data transmission by the symbol group 6701 of PLP #1 shown in
In
In
For the sake of simplicity,
As set forth above, no PLPs using “a transmission scheme for transmitting only stream s1” exist in a unit frame, so that the dynamic range of a signal received by the terminal is ensured to be narrow. As a result, the advantageous effect is achieved that the probability of excellent reception quality increases.
Note that the description of
The above description relates to an example in which α unit frame includes a plurality of PLPs. The following describes an example in which α unit frame includes one PLP only.
In
In the example shown in
In the second unit frame, a symbol group 6802 for PLP #2-1 is transmitted and the transmission scheme selected is “a scheme for transmitting one modulated signal.”
In the third unit frame, a symbol group 6803 for PLP #3-1 is transmitted and the transmission scheme selected is “a precoding scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices”.
In the fourth unit frame, a symbol group 6804 for PLP #4-1 is transmitted and the transmission scheme selected is “space-time block coding”. Note that the symbol arrangement used in the space-time block coding is not limited to the arrangement in the time domain. Alternatively, the symbols may be arranged in the frequency domain or in symbol groups formed in the time and frequency domains. In addition, the space-time block coding is not limited to the one shown in
In
In the above manner, a transmission scheme may be set for each PLP in consideration of the data transmission speed and the data reception quality at the receiving terminal, so that increase in data transmission seeped and excellent reception quality are both achieved. As an example scheme of structuring control information, the control information indicating, for example, the transmission scheme and other information of the P1 symbol and first and second Signalling data may be configured in a similar manner to Tables 3-6. The difference is as follows. In the frame structure shown, for example, in
The present embodiment has described how a precoding scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices is applied to a system compliant with the DVB standard. Embodiments 1 to 16 have described examples of the precoding scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices. However, the scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices is not limited to the schemes described in Embodiments 1 to 16. The present embodiment can be implemented in the same manner by using a scheme comprising the steps of (i) preparing a plurality of precoding matrices, (ii) selecting, from among the prepared plurality of precoding matrices, one precoding matrix for each slot, and (iii) performing the precoding while regularly hopping between precoding matrices to be used for each slot.
Although control information has unique names in the present embodiment, the names of the control information do not influence the present invention.
The present embodiment provides detailed descriptions of a reception scheme and the structure of a reception device used in a case where a scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices is applied to a communication system compliant with the DVB-T2 standard, which is described in Embodiment A1.
Referring to
Signals 704_X and 704_Y that have been subjected to signal processing, as well as the P1 symbol control information 7302, are input to a P2 symbol demodulation unit 7303 (note, a P2 symbol may include a signalling PLP). The P2 symbol demodulation unit 7303 performs signal processing and demodulation (including error correction decoding) based on the P1 symbol control information, and outputs P2 symbol control information 7304.
The P1 symbol control information 7302 and the P2 symbol control information 7304 are input to a control signal generating unit 7305. The control signal generating unit 7305 forms a set of pieces of control information (relating to receiving operations) and outputs the same as a control signal 7306. As illustrated in
A signal processing unit 711 receives, as inputs, the signals 706_1, 706_2, 708_1, 708_2, 704_X, 704_Y, and the control signal 7306. Based on the information included in the control signal 7306 on the transmission scheme, modulation scheme, error correction coding scheme, coding rate for error correction coding, block size of error correction codes, and the like used to transmit each PLP, the signal processing unit 711 performs demodulation processing and decoding processing, and outputs received data 712.
Here, the signal processing unit 711 may perform demodulation processing by using Equation 41 of Math 41 and Equation 143 of Math 153 in a case where any of the following transmission schemes is used for to transmit each PLP: a spatial multiplexing MIMO system; a MIMO scheme employing a fixed precoding matrix; and a precoding scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices. Note that the channel matrix (H) can be obtained from the resultant outputs from channel fluctuation estimating units (705_1, 705_2, 707_1 and 707_2). The matrix structure of the precoding matrix (F or W) differs depending on the transmission scheme actually used. Especially, when the precoding scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices is used, the precoding matrices to be used are hopped between and demodulation is performed every time. Also, when space-time block coding is used, demodulation is performed by using values obtained from channel estimation and a received (baseband) signal.
The reception device shown in
Signals 704_X and 704_Y that have been subjected to signal processing, as well as the P1 symbol control information 7302, are input to a first/second signalling data demodulation unit 7401. The first/second signalling data demodulation unit 7401 performs signal processing and demodulation (including error correction decoding) based on the P1 symbol control information, and outputs first/second signalling data control information 7402.
The P1 symbol control information 7302 and the first/second signalling data control information 7402 are input to a control signal generating unit 7305. The control signal generating unit 7305 forms a set of pieces of control information (relating to receiving operations) and outputs the same as a control signal 7306. As illustrated in
A signal processing unit 711 receives, as inputs, the signals 706_1, 706_2, 708_1, 708_2, 704_X, 704_Y, and the control signal 7306. Based on the information included in the control signal 7306 on the transmission scheme, modulation scheme, error correction coding scheme, coding rate for error correction coding, block size of error correction codes, and the like used to transmit each PLP, the signal processing unit 711 performs demodulation processing and decoding processing, and outputs received data 712.
Here, the signal processing unit 711 may perform demodulation processing by using Equation 41 of Math 41 and Equation 143 of Math 153 in a case where any of the following transmission schemes is used to transmit each PLP: a spatial multiplexing MIMO system; a MIMO scheme employing a fixed precoding matrix; and a precoding scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices. Note that the channel matrix (H) can be obtained from the resultant outputs from channel fluctuation estimating units (705_1, 705_2, 707_1 and 707_2). The matrix structure of the precoding matrix (F or W) differs depending on the transmission scheme actually used. Especially, when the precoding scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices is used, the precoding matrices to be used are hopped between and demodulation is performed every time. Also, when space-time block coding is used, demodulation is performed by using values obtained from channel estimation and a received (baseband) signal.
The reception device shown in
Signals 704_X and 704_Y that have been subjected to signal processing, as well as P1 symbol control information 7302, are input to the P2 symbol or first/second signalling data demodulation unit 7501. Based on the P1 symbol control information, the P2 symbol or first/second signalling data demodulation unit 7501 judges whether the received signal is compliant with the DVB-T2 standard or with a standard other than the DVB-T2 standard (this judgment can be made with use of, for example, Table 3), performs signal processing and demodulation (including error correction decoding), and outputs control information 7502 that includes information indicating the standard with which the received signal is compliant. Other operations are similar to
As set forth above, the structure of the reception device described in the present embodiment allows obtaining data with high reception quality by receiving the signal transmitted by the transmission device of the broadcast station, which has been described in Embodiment A1, and by performing appropriate signal processing. Especially, when receiving a signal associated with a precoding scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices, both the data transmission efficiency and the data reception quality can be improved in an LOS environment.
As the present embodiment has described the structure of the reception device that corresponds to the transmission scheme used by the broadcast station described in Embodiment A1, the reception device is provided with two receive antennas in the present embodiment. However, the number of antennas provided in the reception device is not limited to two. The present embodiment can be implemented in the same manner when the reception device is provided with three or more antennas. In this case, the data reception quality can be improved due to an increase in the diversity gain. Furthermore, when the transmission device of the broadcast station is provided with three or more transmit antennas and transmits three or more modulated signals, the present embodiment can be implemented in the same manner by increasing the number of receive antennas provided in the reception device of the terminal. In this case, it is preferable that the precoding scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices be used as a transmission scheme.
Note that Embodiments 1 to 16 have described examples of the precoding scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices. However, the scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices is not limited to the schemes described in Embodiments 1 to 16. The present embodiment can be implemented in the same manner by using a scheme comprising the steps of (i) preparing a plurality of precoding matrices, (ii) selecting, from among the prepared plurality of precoding matrices, one precoding matrix for each slot, and (iii) performing the precoding while regularly hopping between precoding matrices to be used for each slot.
In the system described in Embodiment A1 where the precoding scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices is applied to the DVB-T2 standard, there is control information for designating a pilot insertion pattern in L1 pre-signalling. The present embodiment describes how to apply the precoding scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices when the pilot insertion pattern is changed in the L1 pre-signalling.
In
Next, a description is given of how to apply the precoding scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices in association with a pilot insertion scheme. By way of example, it is assumed here that 10 different types of precoding matrices F are prepared for the precoding scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices, and these 10 different types of precoding matrices F are expressed as F[0], F[1], F[2], F[3], F[4], F[5], F[6], F[7], F[8], and F[9].
It should be naturally appreciated that different schemes for inserting pilot symbols (different insertion intervals) are used for the frame structure represented in the frequency-time domain shown in
Therefore, the broadcast station transmits control information indicating a pilot pattern (pilot insertion scheme) using the L1 pre-signalling data. Note, when the broadcast station has selected the precoding scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices as a scheme for transmitting each PLP based on control information shown in Table 4 or 5, the control information indicating the pilot pattern (pilot insertion scheme) may additionally indicate a scheme for allocating the precoding matrices (hereinafter “precoding matrix allocation scheme”) prepared for the precoding scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices. Hence, the reception device of the terminal that receives modulated signals transmitted by the broadcast station can acknowledge the precoding matrix allocation scheme used in the precoding scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices by obtaining the control information indicating the pilot pattern, which is included in the L1 pre-signalling data (on the premise that the broadcast station has selected the precoding scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices as a scheme for transmitting each PLP based on control information shown in Table 4 or 5). Although the description of the present embodiment has been given with reference to L1 pre-signalling data, in the case of the frame structure shown in
The following describes another example. For example, the above description is also true of a case where the precoding matrices used in the precoding scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices are determined at the same time as designation of a modulation scheme, as shown in Table 2. In this case, by transmitting only the pieces of control information indicating a pilot pattern, a scheme for transmitting each PLP and a modulation scheme from P2 symbols, the reception device of the terminal can estimate, via obtainment of these pieces of control information, the precoding matrix allocation scheme used in the precoding scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices (note, the allocation is performed in the frequency-time domain). Assume a case where the precoding matrices used in the precoding scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices are determined at the same time as designation of a modulation scheme and an error correction coding scheme, as shown in Table 1B. In this case also, by transmitting only the pieces of control information indicating a pilot pattern, a scheme for transmitting each PLP and a modulation scheme, as well as an error correction coding scheme, from P2 symbols, the reception device of the terminal can estimate, via obtainment of these pieces of information, the precoding matrix allocation scheme used in the precoding scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices (note, the allocation is performed in the frequency-time domain).
However, unlike the cases of Tables 1B and 2, a precoding matrix hopping scheme used in the precoding scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices is transmitted, as indicated by Table 5, in any of the following situations (i) to (iii): (i) when one of two or more different schemes of regularly hopping between precoding matrices can be selected even if the modulation scheme is determined (examples of such two or more different schemes include: precoding schemes that regularly hop between precoding matrices over different periods (cycles); and precoding schemes that regularly hop between precoding matrices, where the precoding matrices used in one scheme is different from those used in another; (ii) when one of two or more different schemes of regularly hopping between precoding matrices can be selected even if the modulation scheme and the error correction scheme are determined; and (iii) when one of two or more different schemes of regularly hopping between precoding matrices can be selected even if the error correction scheme is determined. In any of these situations (i) to (iii), it is permissible to transmit information on the precoding matrix allocation scheme used in the precoding scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices, in addition to the precoding matrix hopping scheme used in the precoding scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices (note, the allocation is performed in the frequency-time domain).
Table 7 shows an example of the structure of control information for the information on the precoding matrix allocation scheme used in the precoding scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices (note, the allocation is performed in the frequency-time domain).
By way of example, assume a case where the transmission device of the broadcast station has selected the pilot insertion pattern shown in
As set forth above, by implementing the precoding matrix allocation scheme used in the precoding scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices based on the pilot insertion scheme, and by properly transmitting the information indicative of the precoding matrix allocation scheme to the transmission destination (terminal), the reception device of the terminal can achieve the advantageous effect of improving both the data transmission efficiency and the data reception quality.
The present embodiment has described a case where the broadcast station transmits two signals. However, the present embodiment can be implemented in the same manner when the transmission device of the broadcast station is provided with three or more transmit antennas and transmits three or more modulated signals. Embodiments 1 to 16 have described examples of the precoding scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices. However, the scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices is not limited to the schemes described in Embodiments 1 to 16. The present embodiment can be implemented in the same manner by using a scheme comprising the steps of (i) preparing a plurality of precoding matrices, (ii) selecting, from among the prepared plurality of precoding matrices, one precoding matrix for each slot, and (iii) performing the precoding while regularly hopping between precoding matrices to be used for each slot.
In the present embodiment, a description is given of a repetition scheme used in a precoding scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices in order to improve the data reception quality.
A baseband signal 8101_1 shown in
The baseband signal 8101_1 and a control signal 8104 are input to a signal processing unit (duplicating unit) 8102_1. The signal processing unit (duplicating unit) 8102_1 generates duplicates of the baseband signal in accordance with the information on the number of repetitions included in the control signal 8104. For example, in a case where the information on the number of repetitions included in the control signal 8104 indicates four repetitions, provided that the baseband signal 8101_1 includes signals s11, s12, s13, s14, . . . arranged in the stated order along the time axis, the signal processing unit (duplicating unit) 8102_1 generates a duplicate of each signal four times, and outputs the resultant duplicates. That is, after the four repetitions, the signal processing unit (duplicating unit) 8102_1 outputs, as the baseband signal 8103_1, four pieces of s11 (i.e., s11, s11, s11, s11), four pieces of s12 (i.e., s12, s12, s12, s12), four pieces of s13 (i.e., s13, s13, s13, s13), four pieces of s14 (i.e., s14, s14, s14, s14) and so on, in the stated order along the time axis.
The baseband signal 8101_2 and the control signal 8104 are input to a signal processing unit (duplicating unit) 8102_2. The signal processing unit (duplicating unit) 8102_2 generates duplicates of the baseband signal in accordance with the information on the number of repetitions included in the control signal 8104. For example, in a case where the information on the number of repetitions included in the control signal 8104 indicates four repetitions, provided that the baseband signal 8101_2 includes signals s21, s22, s23, s24, . . . arranged in the stated order along the time axis, the signal processing unit (duplicating unit) 8102_2 generates a duplicate of each signal four times, and outputs the resultant duplicates. That is, after the four repetitions, the signal processing unit (duplicating unit) 8102_2 outputs, as the baseband signal 8103_2, four pieces of s21 (i.e., s21, s21, s21, s21), four pieces of s22 (i.e., s22, s22, s22, s22), four pieces of s23 (i.e., s23, s23, s23, s13), four pieces of s24 (i.e., s14, s24, s24, s24) and so on, in the stated order along the time axis.
The baseband signals 8103_1 and 8103_2 obtained as a result of repetitions, as well as the control signal 8104, are input to a weighting unit (precoding operation unit) 8105. The weighting unit (precoding operation unit) 8105 performs precoding based on the information on the precoding scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices, which is included in the control signal 8104. More specifically, the weighting unit (precoding operation unit) 8105 performs weighting on the baseband signals 8103_1 and 8103_2 obtained as a result of repetitions, and outputs baseband signals 8106_1 and 8106_2 on which the precoding has been performed (here, the baseband signals 8106_1 and 8106_2 are respectively expressed as z1(i) and z2(i), where i represents the order (along time or frequency)).
Provided that the baseband signals 8103_1 and 8103_2 obtained as a result of repetitions are respectively y1(i) and y2(i) and the precoding matrix is F(i), the following relationship is satisfied.
Provided that N precoding matrices prepared for the precoding scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices are F[0], F[1], F[2], F[3], . . . , F[N−1] (where N is an integer larger than or equal to two), one of the precoding matrices F[0], F[1], F[2], F[3], . . . , F[N−1] is used as F(i) in Equation 475.
By way of example, assume that i=0, 1, 2, 3; y1(i) represents four duplicated baseband signals s11, s11, s11, s11; and y2(i) represents four duplicated baseband signals s21, s21, s21, s21. Under this assumption, it is important that the following condition be met.
For ∀α∀β, the relationship F(α)≠F(β) is satisfied (for α,β=0,1,2,3 and α≠β). Math 562
The following description is derived by generalizing the above. Assume that the number of repetitions is K; i=g0, g1, g2, . . . , gK-1 (i.e., gj where j is an integer in a range of 0 to K−1); and y1(i) represents s11. Under this assumption, it is important that the following condition be met.
For ∀α∀β, the relationship F(α)≠F(β) is satisfied (for α, β=gj (j being an integer in a range of 0 to K−1) and α≠β). Math 563
Likewise, assume that the number of repetitions is K; i=h0, h1, h2, . . . , hK-1 (i.e., hj where j is an integer in a range of 0 to K−1); and y2(i) represents s21. Under this assumption, it is important that the following condition be met.
For ∀α∀β, the relationship F(α)≠F(β) is satisfied (for α, β=hj (j being an integer in a range of 0 to K−1) and α≠β). Math 564
Here, the relationship gj=hj may be or may not be satisfied. This way, the identical streams generated through the repetitions are transmitted while using different precoding matrices therefor, and thus the advantageous effect of improving the data reception quality is achieved.
The present embodiment has described a case where the broadcast station transmits two signals. However, the present embodiment can be implemented in the same manner when the transmission device of the broadcast station is provided with three or more transmit antennas and transmits three or more modulated signals. Assume that the number of transmitted signals is Q; the number of repetitions is K; i=g0, g1, g2, . . . , gK-1 (i.e., gj where j is an integer in a range of 0 to K−1); and yb(i) represents sb1 (where b is an integer in a range of 1 to Q). Under this assumption, it is important that the following condition be met.
For ∀α∀β, the relationship F(α)≠F(β) is satisfied (for α, β=gj (j being an integer in a range of 0 to K−1) and α≠β). Math 565
Note that F(i) is a precoding matrix pertaining to a case where the number of transmitted signals is Q.
Next, an embodiment different from the embodiment illustrated in
A baseband signal 8101_1 shown in
The baseband signal 8101_1 and the control signal 8104 are input to a signal processing unit (duplicating unit) 8102_1. The signal processing unit (duplicating unit) 8102_1 generates duplicates of the baseband signal in accordance with the information on the number of repetitions included in the control signal 8104. For example, in a case where the information on the number of repetitions included in the control signal 8104 indicates four repetitions, provided that the baseband signal 8101_1 includes signals s11, s12, s13, s14, . . . arranged in the stated order along the time axis, the signal processing unit (duplicating unit) 8102_1 generates a duplicate of each signal four times, and outputs the resultant duplicates. That is, after the four repetitions, the signal processing unit (duplicating unit) 8102_1 outputs, as the baseband signal 8103_1, four pieces of s11 (i.e., s11, s11, s11, s11), four pieces of s12 (i.e., s12, s12, s12, s12), four pieces of s13 (i.e., s13, s13, s13, s13), four pieces of s14 (i.e., s14, s14, s14, s14) and so on, in the stated order along the time axis.
The baseband signal 8101_2 and the control signal 8104 are input to a signal processing unit (duplicating unit) 8102_2. The signal processing unit (duplicating unit) 8102_2 generates duplicates of the baseband signal in accordance with the information on the number of repetitions included in the control signal 8104. For example, in a case where the information on the number of repetitions included in the control signal 8104 indicates four repetitions, provided that the baseband signal 8101_2 includes signals s21, s22, s23, s24, . . . arranged in the stated order along the time axis, the signal processing unit (duplicating unit) 8102_1 generates a duplicate of each signal four times, and outputs the resultant duplicates. That is, after the four repetitions, the signal processing unit (duplicating unit) 8102_2 outputs, as the baseband signal 8103_2, four pieces of s21 (i.e., s21, s21, s21, s21), four pieces of s22 (i.e., s22, s22, s22, s22), four pieces of s23 (i.e., s23, s23, s23, s23), four pieces of s24 (i.e., s24, s24, s24, s24) and so on, in the stated order along the time axis.
The baseband signals 8103_1 and 8103_2 obtained as a result of repetitions, as well as the control signal 8104, are input to a reordering unit 8201. The reordering unit 8201 reorders the data pieces in accordance with information on a repetition scheme included in the control signal 8104, and outputs baseband signals 8202_1 and 8202_2 obtained as a result of reordering. For example, assume that the baseband signal 8103_1 obtained as a result of repetitions is composed of four pieces of s11 (s11, s11, s11, s11) arranged along the time axis, and the baseband signal 8103_2 obtained as a result of repetitions is composed of four pieces of s21 (s21, s21, s21, s21) arranged along the time axis. In
The baseband signals 8202_1 and 8202_2 obtained as a result of reordering, as well as the control signal 8104, are input to a weighting unit (precoding operation unit) 8105. The weighting unit (precoding operation unit) 8105 performs precoding based on the information on the precoding scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices, which is included in the control signal 8104. More specifically, the weighting unit (precoding operation unit) 8105 performs weighting on the baseband signals 8202_1 and 8202_2 obtained as a result of reordering, and outputs baseband signals 8106_1 and 8106_2 on which the precoding has been performed (here, the baseband signals 8106_1 and 8106_2 are respectively expressed as z1(i) and z2(i), where i represents the order (along time or frequency)).
As described earlier, under the assumption that the baseband signals 8202_1 and 8202_2 obtained as a result of reordering are respectively y1(i) and y2(i) and the precoding matrix is F(i), the relationship in Equation 475 is satisfied.
Provided that N precoding matrices prepared for the precoding scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices are F[0], F[1], F[2], F[3], . . . , F[N−1] (where N is an integer larger than or equal to two), one of the precoding matrices F[0], F[1], F[2], F[3], . . . , F[N−1] is used as F(i) in Equation 475.
Although it has been described above that four repetitions are performed, the number of repetitions is not limited to four. As with the structure shown in
The structure of the reception device is illustrated in
The present embodiment has described a scheme for applying a precoding scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices in the case where the repetitions are performed. When there are two types of slots, i.e., slots over which data is transmitted after performing the repetitions, and slots over which data is transmitted without performing the repetitions, either of a precoding scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices or a precoding scheme employing a fixed precoding matrix may be used as a transmission scheme for the slots over which data is transmitted without performing the repetitions. Put another way, in order for the reception device to achieve high data reception quality, it is important that the transmission scheme pertaining to the present embodiment be used for the slots over which data is transmitted after performing the repetitions.
In the systems associated with the DVB standard that have been described in Embodiments A1 through A3, it is necessary to secure higher reception qualities for P2 symbols, first signalling data and second signalling data than for PLPs. When P2 symbols, first signalling data and second signalling data are transmitted by using the precoding scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices described in the present embodiment, which incorporates the repetitions, the reception quality of control information improves in the reception device. This is important for stable operations of the systems.
Embodiments 1 to 16 have provided examples of the precoding scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices described in the present embodiment. However, the scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices is not limited to the schemes described in Embodiments 1 to 16. The present embodiment can be implemented in the same manner by using a scheme comprising the steps of (i) preparing a plurality of precoding matrices, (ii) selecting, from among the prepared plurality of precoding matrices, one precoding matrix for each slot, and (iii) performing the precoding while regularly hopping between precoding matrices for each slot.
The present embodiment describes a scheme for transmitting modulated signals by applying common amplification to the transmission scheme described in Embodiment A1.
Modulated signal generating units #1 to # M (i.e., 5201_1 to 5201_M) shown in
The modulated signals z1 (5202_1 to 5202_M) are input to a wireless processing unit 8301_1 shown in
Similarly, the modulated signals z2 (5203_1 to 5203_M) are input to a wireless processing unit 8301_2. The wireless processing unit 8301_2 performs signal processing (e.g., frequency conversion) and amplification, and outputs a modulated signal 8302_2. Thereafter, the modulated signal 8302_2 is output from an antenna 8303_2 as a radio wave.
As set forth above, it is permissible to use the transmission scheme described in Embodiment A1 while performing frequency conversion and amplification simultaneously on modulated signals having different frequency bandwidths.
The following describes a structural example of an application of the transmission schemes and reception schemes shown in the above embodiments and a system using the application.
An antenna (for example, antennas 8560 and 8440) internal to each reception device, or provided externally and connected to the reception device, receives the signal transmitted from the broadcasting station 8401. Each reception device obtains the multiplexed data by using the reception schemes in the above embodiments to demodulate the signal received by the antenna. In this way, the digital broadcasting system 8400 obtains the advantageous effects of the present invention described in the above embodiments.
The video data included in the multiplexed data has been coded with a moving picture coding method compliant with a standard such as Moving Picture Experts Group (MPEG)-2, MPEG-4 Advanced Video Coding (AVC), VC-1, or the like. The audio data included in the multiplexed data has been encoded with an audio coding method compliant with a standard such as Dolby Audio Coding (AC)-3, Dolby Digital Plus, Meridian Lossless Packing (MLP), Digital Theater Systems (DTS), DTS-HD, Linear Pulse-Code Modulation (PCM), or the like.
The reception device 8500 includes a stream input/output unit 8520, a signal processing unit 8504, an audio output unit 8506, and a video display unit 8507. The stream input/output unit 8520 demultiplexes video and audio data from multiplexed data obtained by the demodulation unit 8502. The signal processing unit 8504 decodes the demultiplexed video data into a video signal using an appropriate method picture decoding method and decodes the demultiplexed audio data into an audio signal using an appropriate audio decoding scheme. The audio output unit 8506, such as a speaker, produces audio output according to the decoded audio signal. The video display unit 8507, such as a display monitor, produces video output according to the decoded video signal.
For example, the user may operate the remote control 8550 to select a channel (of a TV program or audio broadcast), so that information indicative of the selected channel is transmitted to an operation input unit 8510. In response, the reception device 8500 demodulates, from among signals received with the antenna 8560, a signal carried on the selected channel and applies error correction decoding, so that reception data is extracted. At this time, the reception device 8500 receives control symbols included in a signal corresponding to the selected channel and containing information indicating the transmission scheme (the transmission scheme, modulation scheme, error correction scheme, and the like in the above embodiments) of the signal (exactly as described in Embodiments A1 through A4 and as shown in
With the above structure, the user can view a broadcast program that the reception device 8500 receives by the reception schemes described in the above embodiments.
The reception device 8500 according to this embodiment may additionally include a recording unit (drive) 8508 for recording various data onto a recording medium, such as a magnetic disk, optical disc, or a non-volatile semiconductor memory. Examples of data to be recorded by the recording unit 8508 include data contained in multiplexed data that is obtained as a result of demodulation and error correction decoding by the demodulation unit 8502, data equivalent to such data (for example, data obtained by compressing the data), and data obtained by processing the moving pictures and/or audio. (Note here that there may be a case where no error correction decoding is applied to a signal obtained as a result of demodulation by the demodulation unit 8502 and where the reception device 8500 conducts further signal processing after error correction decoding. The same holds in the following description where similar wording appears.) Note that the term “optical disc” used herein refers to a recording medium, such as Digital Versatile Disc (DVD) or BD (Blu-ray Disc), that is readable and writable with the use of a laser beam. Further, the term “magnetic disk” used herein refers to a recording medium, such as a floppy disk (FD, registered trademark) or hard disk, that is writable by magnetizing a magnetic substance with magnetic flux. Still further, the term “non-volatile semiconductor memory” refers to a recording medium, such as flash memory or ferroelectric random access memory, composed of semiconductor element(s). Specific examples of non-volatile semiconductor memory include an SD card using flash memory and a flash Solid State Drive (SSD). It should be naturally appreciated that the specific types of recording media mentioned herein are merely examples, and any other types of recording mediums may be usable.
With the above structure, the user can record a broadcast program that the reception device 8500 receives with any of the reception schemes described in the above embodiments, and time-shift viewing of the recorded broadcast program is possible anytime after the broadcast.
In the above description of the reception device 8500, the recording unit 8508 records multiplexed data obtained as a result of demodulation and error correction decoding by the demodulation unit 8502. However, the recording unit 8508 may record part of data extracted from the data contained in the multiplexed data. For example, the multiplexed data obtained as a result of demodulation and error correction decoding by the demodulation unit 8502 may contain contents of data broadcast service, in addition to video data and audio data. In this case, new multiplexed data may be generated by multiplexing the video data and audio data, without the contents of broadcast service, extracted from the multiplexed data demodulated by the demodulation unit 8502, and the recording unit 8508 may record the newly generated multiplexed data. Alternatively, new multiplexed data may be generated by multiplexing either of the video data and audio data contained in the multiplexed data obtained as a result of demodulation and error correction decoding by the demodulation unit 8502, and the recording unit 8508 may record the newly generated multiplexed data. The recording unit 8508 may also record the contents of data broadcast service included, as described above, in the multiplexed data.
The reception device 8500 described in this embodiment may be included in a television, a recorder (such as DVD recorder, Blu-ray recorder, HDD recorder, SD card recorder, or the like), or a mobile telephone. In such a case, the multiplexed data obtained as a result of demodulation and error correction decoding by the demodulation unit 8502 may contain data for correcting errors (bugs) in software used to operate the television or recorder or in software used to prevent disclosure of personal or confidential information. If such data is contained, the data is installed on the television or recorder to correct the software errors. Further, if data for correcting errors (bugs) in software installed in the reception device 8500 is contained, such data is used to correct errors that the reception device 8500 may have. This arrangement ensures more stable operation of the TV, recorder, or mobile phone in which the reception device 8500 is implemented.
Note that it may be the stream input/output unit 8503 that handles extraction of data from the whole data contained in multiplexed data obtained as a result of demodulation and error correction decoding by the demodulation unit 8502 and multiplexing of the extracted data. More specifically, under instructions given from a control unit not illustrated in the figures, such as a CPU, the stream input/output unit 8503 demultiplexes video data, audio data, contents of data broadcast service etc. from the multiplexed data demodulated by the demodulation unit 8502, extracts specific pieces of data from the demultiplexed data, and multiplexes the extracted data pieces to generate new multiplexed data. The data pieces to be extracted from demultiplexed data may be determined by the user or determined in advance for the respective types of recording mediums.
With the above structure, the reception device 8500 is enabled to extract and record only data necessary to view a recorded broadcast program, which is effective to reduce the size of data to be recorded.
In the above description, the recording unit 8508 records multiplexed data obtained as a result of demodulation and error correction decoding by the demodulation unit 8502. Alternatively, however, the recording unit 8508 may record new multiplexed data generated by multiplexing video data newly yielded by encoding the original video data contained in the multiplexed data obtained as a result of demodulation and error correction decoding by the demodulation unit 8502. Here, the moving picture coding method to be employed may be different from that used to encode the original video data, so that the data size or bit rate of the new video data is smaller than the original video data. Here, the moving picture coding method used to generate new video data may be of a different standard from that used to generate the original video data. Alternatively, the same moving picture coding method may be used but with different parameters. Similarly, the recording unit 8508 may record new multiplexed data generated by multiplexing audio data newly obtained by encoding the original audio data contained in the multiplexed data obtained as a result of demodulation and error correction decoding by the demodulation unit 8502. Here, the audio coding method to be employed may be different from that used to encode the original audio data, such that the data size or bit rate of the new audio data is smaller than the original audio data.
The process of converting the original video or audio data contained in the multiplexed data obtained as a result of demodulation and error correction decoding by the demodulation unit 8502 into the video or audio data of a different data size of bit rate is performed, for example, by the stream input/output unit 8503 and the signal processing unit 8504. More specifically, under instructions given from the control unit such as the CPU, the stream input/output unit 8503 demultiplexes video data, audio data, contents of data broadcast service etc. from the multiplexed data obtained as a result of demodulation and error correction decoding by the demodulation unit 8502. Under instructions given from the control unit, the signal processing unit 8504 converts the demultiplexed video data and audio data respectively using a moving picture coding method and an audio coding method each different from the method that was used in the conversion applied to obtain the video and audio data. Under instructions given from the control unit, the stream input/output unit 8503 multiplexes the newly converted video data and audio data to generate new multiplexed data. Note that the signal processing unit 8504 may perform the conversion of either or both of the video or audio data according to instructions given from the control unit. In addition, the sizes of video data and audio data to be obtained by encoding may be specified by a user or determined in advance for the types of recording mediums.
With the above arrangement, the reception device 8500 is enabled to record video and audio data after converting the data to a size recordable on the recording medium or to a size or bit rate that matches the read or write rate of the recording unit 8508. This arrangement enables the recoding unit to duly record a program, even if the size recordable on the recording medium is smaller than the data size of the multiplexed data obtained as a result of demodulation and error correction decoding by the demodulation unit 8502, or if the rate at which the recording unit records or reads is lower than the bit rate of the multiplexed data. Consequently, time-shift viewing of the recorded program by the user is possible anytime after the broadcast.
Furthermore, the reception device 8500 additionally includes a stream output interface (IF) 8509 for transmitting multiplexed data demodulated by the demodulation unit 8502 to an external device via a transport medium 8530. In one example, the stream output IF 8509 may be a wireless communication device that transmits multiplexed data via a wireless medium (equivalent to the transport medium 8530) to an external device by modulating the multiplexed data in accordance with a wireless communication scheme compliant with a wireless communication standard such as Wi-Fi (registered trademark, a set of standards including IEEE 802.11a, IEEE 802.11b, IEEE 802.11g, and IEEE 802.11n), WiGiG, Wireless HD, Bluetooth (registered trademark), ZigBee (registered trademark), or the like. The stream output IF 8509 may also be a wired communication device that transmits multiplexed data via a transmission line (equivalent to the transport medium 8530) physically connected to the stream output IF 8509 to an external device, modulating the multiplexed data using a communication scheme compliant with wired communication standards, such as Ethernet (registered trademark), Universal Serial Bus (USB), Power Line Communication (PLC), or High-Definition Multimedia Interface (HDMI).
With the above structure, the user can use, on an external device, multiplexed data received by the reception device 8500 using the reception scheme described according to the above embodiments. The usage of multiplexed data by the user mentioned herein includes use of the multiplexed data for real-time viewing on an external device, recording of the multiplexed data by a recording unit included in an external device, and transmission of the multiplexed data from an external device to a yet another external device.
In the above description of the reception device 8500, the stream output IF 8509 outputs multiplexed data obtained as a result of demodulation and error correction decoding by the demodulation unit 8502. However, the reception device 8500 may output data extracted from data contained in the multiplexed data, rather than the whole data contained in the multiplexed data. For example, the multiplexed data obtained as a result of demodulation and error correction decoding by the demodulation unit 8502 may contain contents of data broadcast service, in addition to video data and audio data. In this case, the stream output IF 8509 may output multiplexed data newly generated by multiplexing video and audio data extracted from the multiplexed data obtained as a result of demodulation and error correction decoding by the demodulation unit 8502. In another example, the stream output IF 8509 may output multiplexed data newly generated by multiplexing either of the video data and audio data contained in the multiplexed data obtained as a result of demodulation and error correction decoding by the demodulation unit 8502.
Note that it may be the stream input/output unit 8503 that handles extraction of data from the whole data contained in multiplexed data obtained as a result of demodulation and error correction decoding by the demodulation unit 8502 and multiplexing of the extracted data. More specifically, under instructions given from a control unit not illustrated in the figures, such as a Central Processing Unit (CPU), the stream input/output unit 8503 demultiplexes video data, audio data, contents of data broadcast service etc. from the multiplexed data demodulated by the demodulation unit 8502, extracts specific pieces of data from the demultiplexed data, and multiplexes the extracted data pieces to generate new multiplexed data. The data pieces to be extracted from demultiplexed data may be determined by the user or determined in advance for the respective types of the stream output IF 8509.
With the above structure, the reception device 8500 is enabled to extract and output only data necessary for an external device, which is effective to reduce the communication bandwidth used to output the multiplexed data.
In the above description, the stream output IF 8509 outputs multiplexed data obtained as a result of demodulation and error correction decoding by the demodulation unit 8502. Alternatively, however, the stream output IF 8509 may output new multiplexed data generated by multiplexing video data newly yielded by encoding the original video data contained in the multiplexed data obtained as a result of demodulation and error correction decoding by the demodulation unit 8502. The new video data is encoded with a moving picture coding method different from that used to encode the original video data, so that the data size or bit rate of the new video data is smaller than the original video data. Here, the moving picture coding method used to generate new video data may be of a different standard from that used to generate the original video data. Alternatively, the same moving picture coding method may be used but with different parameters. Similarly, the stream output IF 8509 may output new multiplexed data generated by multiplexing audio data newly obtained by encoding the original audio data contained in the multiplexed data obtained as a result of demodulation and error correction decoding by the demodulation unit 8502. The new audio data is encoded with an audio coding method different from that used to encode the original audio data, such that the data size or bit rate of the new audio data is smaller than the original audio data.
The process of converting the original video or audio data contained in the multiplexed data obtained as a result of demodulation and error correction decoding by the demodulation unit 8502 into the video or audio data of a different data size of bit rate is performed, for example, by the stream input/output unit 8503 and the signal processing unit 8504. More specifically, under instructions given from the control unit, the stream input/output unit 8503 demultiplexes video data, audio data, contents of data broadcast service etc. from the multiplexed data obtained as a result of demodulation and error correction decoding by the demodulation unit 8502. Under instructions given from the control unit, the signal processing unit 8504 converts the demultiplexed video data and audio data respectively using a moving picture coding method and an audio coding method each different from the method that was used in the conversion applied to obtain the video and audio data. Under instructions given from the control unit, the stream input/output unit 8503 multiplexes the newly converted video data and audio data to generate new multiplexed data. Note that the signal processing unit 8504 may perform the conversion of either or both of the video or audio data according to instructions given from the control unit. In addition, the sizes of video data and audio data to be obtained by conversion may be specified by the user or determined in advance for the types of the stream output IF 8509.
With the above structure, the reception device 8500 is enabled to output video and audio data after converting the data to a bit rate that matches the transfer rate between the reception device 8500 and an external device. This arrangement ensures that even if multiplexed data obtained as a result of demodulation and error correction decoding by the demodulation unit 8502 is higher in bit rate than the data transfer rate to an external device, the stream output IF duly outputs new multiplexed data at an appropriate bit rate to the external device. Consequently, the user can use the new multiplexed data on another communication device.
Furthermore, the reception device 8500 also includes an audio and visual output interface (hereinafter, AV output IF) 8511 that outputs video and audio signals decoded by the signal processing unit 8504 to an external device via an external transport medium. In one example, the AV output IF 8511 may be a wireless communication device that transmits modulated video and audio signals via a wireless medium to an external device, using a wireless communication scheme compliant with wireless communication standards, such as Wi-Fi (registered trademark), which is a set of standards including IEEE 802.11a, IEEE 802.11b, IEEE 802.11g, and IEEE 802.11n, WiGiG, Wireless HD, Bluetooth (registered trademark), ZigBee (registered trademark), or the like. In another example, the stream output IF 8509 may be a wired communication device that transmits modulated video and audio signals via a transmission line physically connected to the stream output IF 8509 to an external device, using a communication scheme compliant with wired communication standards, such as Ethernet (registered trademark), USB, PLC, HDMI, or the like. In yet another example, the stream output IF 8509 may be a terminal for connecting a cable to output the video and audio signals in analog form.
With the above structure, the user is allowed to use, on an external device, the video and audio signals decoded by the signal processing unit 8504.
Furthermore, the reception device 8500 additionally includes an operation input unit 8510 for receiving a user operation. According to control signals indicative of user operations input to the operation input unit 8510, the reception device 8500 performs various operations, such as switching the power ON or OFF, switching the reception channel, switching the display of subtitle text ON or OFF, switching the display of subtitle text to another language, changing the volume of audio output of the audio output unit 8506, and changing the settings of channels that can be received.
Additionally, the reception device 8500 may have a function of displaying the antenna level indicating the quality of the signal being received by the reception device 8500. Note that the antenna level is an indicator of the reception quality calculated based on, for example, the Received Signal Strength Indication, Received Signal Strength Indicator (RSSI), received field strength, Carrier-to-noise power ratio (C/N), Bit Error Rate (BER), packet error rate, frame error rate, and channel state information of the signal received on the reception device 8500. In other words, the antenna level is a signal indicating the level and quality of the received signal. In this case, the demodulation unit 8502 also includes a reception quality measuring unit for measuring the received signal characteristics, such as RSSI, received field strength, C/N, BER, packet error rate, frame error rate, and channel state information. In response to a user operation, the reception device 8500 displays the antenna level (i.e., signal indicating the level and quality of the received signal) on the video display unit 8507 in a manner identifiable by the user. The antenna level (i.e., signal indicating the level and quality of the received signal) may be numerically displayed using a number that represents RSSI, received field strength, C/N, BER, packet error rate, frame error rate, channel state information or the like. Alternatively, the antenna level may be displayed using an image representing RSSI, received field strength, C/N, BER, packet error rate, frame error rate, channel state information or the like. Furthermore, the reception device 8500 may display a plurality of antenna levels (signals indicating the level and quality of the received signal) calculated for each of the plurality of streams s1, s2, . . . received and separated using the reception schemes shown in the above embodiments, or one antenna level (signal indicating the level and quality of the received signal) calculated from the plurality of streams s1, s2, . . . . When video data and audio data composing a program are transmitted hierarchically, the reception device 8500 may also display the signal level (signal indicating the level and quality of the received signal) for each hierarchical level.
With the above structure, users are able to grasp the antenna level (signal indicating the level and quality of the received signal) numerically or visually during reception with the reception schemes shown in the above embodiments.
Although the reception device 8500 is described above as having the audio output unit 8506, video display unit 8507, recording unit 8508, stream output IF 8509, and AV output IF 8511, it is not necessary for the reception device 8500 to have all of these units. As long as the reception device 8500 is provided with at least one of the units described above, the user is enabled to use multiplexed data obtained as a result of demodulation and error correction decoding by the demodulation unit 8502. The reception device 8300 may therefore include any combination of the above-described units depending on its intended use.
(Multiplexed Data)
The following is a detailed description of an exemplary structure of multiplexed data. The data structure typically used in broadcasting is an MPEG2 transport stream (TS), so therefore the following description is given by way of an example related to MPEG2-TS. It should be naturally appreciated, however, that the data structure of multiplexed data transmitted by the transmission and reception schemes described in the above embodiments is not limited to MPEG2-TS and the advantageous effects of the above embodiments are achieved even if any other data structure is employed.
Each stream contained in multiplexed data is identified by an identifier called PID uniquely assigned to the stream. For example, the video stream carrying main video images of a movie is assigned with “0x1011”, each audio stream is assigned with a different one of “0x1100” to “0x111F”, each PG stream is assigned with a different one of “0x1200” to “0x121F”, each IG stream is assigned with a different one of “0x1400” to “0x141F”, each video stream carrying sub video images of the movie is assigned with a different one of “0x1B00” to “0x1B1F”, each audio stream of sub-audio to be mixed with the main audio is assigned with a different one of “0x1A00” to “0x1A1F”.
In addition to the TS packets storing streams such as video, audio, and PG streams, multiplexed data also includes TS packets storing a Program Association Table (PAT), a Program Map Table (PMT), and a Program Clock Reference (PCR). The PAT in multiplexed data indicates the PID of a PMT used in the multiplexed data, and the PID of the PAT is “0”. The PMT includes PIDs identifying the respective streams, such as video, audio and subtitles, contained in multiplexed data and attribute information (frame rate, aspect ratio, and the like) of the streams identified by the respective PIDs. In addition, the PMT includes various types of descriptors relating to the multiplexed data. One of such descriptors may be copy control information indicating whether or not copying of the multiplexed data is permitted. The PCR includes information for synchronizing the Arrival Time Clock (ATC), which is the time axis of ATS, with the System Time Clock (STC), which is the time axis of PTS and DTS. More specifically, the PCR packet includes information indicating an STC time corresponding to the ATS at which the PCR packet is to be transferred.
When recorded onto a recoding medium, for example, the multiplexed data is recorded along with a multiplexed data information file.
As illustrated in
In the present embodiment, from among the pieces of information included in the multiplexed data, the stream type included in the PMT is used. In the case where the multiplexed data is recorded on a recording medium, the video stream attribute information included in the multiplexed data information is used. More specifically, the moving picture coding method and device described in any of the above embodiments may be modified to additionally include a step or unit of setting a specific piece of information in the stream type included in the PMT or in the video stream attribute information. The specific piece of information is for indicating that the video data is generated by the moving picture coding method and device described in the embodiment. With the above structure, video data generated by the moving picture coding method and device described in any of the above embodiments is distinguishable from video data compliant with other standards.
In addition, the video and audio output device 9300 may be operated via the Internet. For example, a terminal connected to the Internet may be used to make settings on the video and audio output device 9300 for pre-programmed recording (storing). (The video and audio output device 9300 therefore would have the recording unit 8508 as illustrated in
Embodiment 2 describes a precoding scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices, and (Example #1) and (Example #2) as schemes of setting precoding matrices in consideration of poor reception points. The present embodiment is directed to generalization of (Example #1) and (Example #2) described in Embodiment 2.
With respect to a scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices with an N-slot period (cycle), a precoding matrix prepared for an N-slot period (cycle) is represented as follows.
In this case, i=0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1. (Let α>0.) In the present embodiment, a unitary matrix is used and the precoding matrix in Equation #1 is represented as follows.
In this case, i=0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1. (Let α>0.) (In order to simplify the mapping performed by the transmission device and the reception device, it is preferable that λ be one of the following fixed values: 0 radians; π/2 radians; π radians; and (3π)/2 radians.) Embodiment 2 is specifically implemented under the assumption α=1. In Embodiment 2, Equation #2 is represented as follows.
In order to distribute the poor reception points evenly with regards to phase in the complex plane, as described in Embodiment 2, Condition #101 or #102 is provided in Equation #1 or #2.
Especially, when θ11(i) is a fixed value independent of i, Condition #103 or #104 may be provided.
Similarly, when θ21(i) is a fixed value independent of i, Condition #105 or #106 may be provided.
The following is an example of a precoding matrix using the above-mentioned unitary matrix for the scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices with an N-slot period (cycle). A precoding matrix that is based on Equation #2 and prepared for an N-slot period (cycle) is represented as follows. (In Equation #2, λ is 0 radians, and θ11(i) is 0 radians.)
In this case, i=0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1. (Let α>0.) Also, Condition #103 or #104 is satisfied. In addition, θ21(i=0) may be set to a certain value, such as 0 radians.
With respect to a scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices with an N-slot period (cycle), another example of a precoding matrix prepared for an N-slot period (cycle) is represented as follows. (In Equation #2, λ is 0 radians, and θ11(i) is 0 radians.)
In this case, i=0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1. (Let α>0.) Also, Condition #103 or #104 is satisfied. In addition, θ21(i=0) may be set to a certain value, such as 0 radians.
As yet another example, a precoding matrix prepared for an N-slot period (cycle) is represented as follows. (In Equation #2, λ is 0 radians, and θ21(i) is 0 radians.)
In this case, i=0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1. (Let α>0.) Also, Condition #105 or #106 is satisfied. In addition, θ11(i=0) may be set to a certain value, such as 0 radians.
As yet another example, a precoding matrix prepared for an N-slot period (cycle) is represented as follows.
(In Equation #2, λ is π radians, and θ21(i) is 0 radians.)
In this case, i=0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1 (let α>0), and Condition #105 or #106 is satisfied. In addition, θ11(i=0) may be set to a certain value, such as 0 radians.
In view of the examples of Embodiment 2, yet another example of a precoding matrix prepared for an N-slot period (cycle) is represented as follows. (In Equation #3, λ is 0 radians, and θ11(i) is 0 radians.)
In this case, i=0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1, and Condition #103 or #104 is satisfied. In addition, θ21(i=0) may be set to a certain value, such as 0 radians.
With respect to a scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices with an N-slot period (cycle), yet another example of a precoding matrix prepared for an N-slot period (cycle) is represented as follows. (In Equation #3, λ is π radians, and θ11(i) is 0 radians.)
In this case, i=0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1, and Condition #103 or #104 is satisfied. In addition, θ21(i=0) may be set to a certain value, such as 0 radians.
As yet another example, a precoding matrix prepared for an N-slot period (cycle) is represented as follows. (In Equation #3, λ is 0 radians, and θ21(i) is 0 radians.)
In this case, i=0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1, and Condition #105 or #106 is satisfied. In addition, θ11(i=0) may be set to a certain value, such as 0 radians.
As yet another example, a precoding matrix prepared for an N-slot period (cycle) is represented as follows. (In Equation #3, λ is π radians, and θ21(i) is 0 radians.)
In this case, i=0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1, and Condition #105 or #106 is satisfied. In addition, θ11(i=0) may be set to a certain value, such as 0 radians.
As compared to the precoding scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices described in Embodiment 9, the precoding scheme pertaining to the present embodiment has a probability of achieving high data reception quality even if the length of the period (cycle) pertaining to the present embodiment is reduced to approximately half of the length of the period (cycle) pertaining to Embodiment 9. Therefore, the precoding scheme pertaining to the present embodiment can reduce the number of precoding matrices to be prepared, which brings about the advantageous effect of reducing the scale of circuits for the transmission device and the reception device. The above advantageous effect can be enhanced with a transmission device that is provided with one encoder and distributes encoded data as shown in
A preferable example of a appearing in the above examples can be obtained by using any of the schemes described in Embodiment 18. However, α is not limited to being obtained in this way.
In the present embodiment, the scheme of structuring N different precoding matrices for a precoding hopping scheme with an N-slot time period (cycle) has been described. In this case, the N different precoding matrices, F[0], F[1], F[2], . . . , F[N−2], F[N−1] are prepared. In the case of a single-carrier transmission scheme, the order F[0], F[1], F[2], . . . , F[N−2], F[N−1] is maintained in the time domain (or the frequency domain). The present invention is not, however, limited in this way, and the N different precoding matrices F[0], F[1], F[2], . . . , F[N−2], F[N−1] generated in the present embodiment may be adapted to a multi-carrier transmission scheme such as an OFDM transmission scheme or the like. As in Embodiment 1, as a scheme of adaption in this case, precoding weights may be changed by arranging symbols in the frequency domain and in the frequency-time domain. Note that a precoding hopping scheme with an N-slot period (cycle) has been described, but the same advantageous effects may be obtained by randomly using N different precoding matrices. In other words, the N different precoding matrices do not necessarily need to be used in a regular period (cycle).
Furthermore, in the precoding matrix hopping scheme over an H-slot period (cycle) (H being a natural number larger than the number of slots N in the period (cycle) of the above scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices), when the N different precoding matrices of the present embodiment are included, the probability of excellent reception quality increases.
The following describes a precoding scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices that is different from Embodiment C1 where Embodiment 9 is incorporated—i.e., a scheme of implementing Embodiment C1 in a case where the number of slots in a period (cycle) is an odd number in Embodiment 9.
With respect to a scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices with an N-slot period (cycle), a precoding matrix prepared for an N-slot period (cycle) is represented as follows.
In this case, i=0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1 (let α>0). In the present embodiment, a unitary matrix is used and the precoding matrix in Equation #1 is represented as follows.
In this case, i=0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1 (let α>0). (In order to simplify the mapping performed by the transmission device and the reception device, it is preferable that λ be one of the following fixed values: 0 radians; π/2 radians; π radians; and (3π)/2 radians.) Specifically, it is assumed here that α=1. Here, Equation #19 is represented as follows.
The precoding matrices used in the precoding scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices pertaining to the present embodiment are expressed in the above manner. The present embodiment is characterized in that the number of slots in an N-slot period (cycle) for the precoding scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices pertaining to the present embodiment is an odd number, i.e., expressed as N=2n+1. To realize an N-slot period (cycle) where N=2n+1, the number of different precoding matrices to be prepared is n+1 (note, the description of these different precoding matrices will be given later). From among the n+1 different precoding matrices, each of then precoding matrices is used twice in one period (cycle), and the remaining one precoding matrix is used once in one period (cycle), which results in an N-slot period (cycle) where N=2n+1. The following is a detailed description of these precoding matrices.
Assume that the n+1 different precoding matrices, which are necessary to implement the precoding scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices with an N-slot period (cycle) where N=2n+1, are F[0], F[1], . . . , F[i], . . . , F[n−1], F[n] (i=0, 1, 2, . . . , n−2, n−1, n). Here, the n+1 different precoding matrices F[0], F[1], . . . , F[i], . . . , F[n−1], F[n] based on Equation #19 are represented as follows.
In this case, i=0, 1, 2, . . . , n−2, n−1, n. Out of the n+1 different precoding matrices according to Equation #21 (namely, F[0], F[1], . . . , F[i], . . . , F[n−1], F[n]), F[0] is used once, and each of F[1] through F[n] is used twice (i.e., F[1] is used twice, F[2] is used twice, . . . , F[n−1] is used twice, and F[n] is used twice). As a result, the precoding scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices with an N-slot period (cycle) where N=2n+1 is achieved, and the reception device can achieve excellent data reception quality, similarly to the case where the number of slots in a period (cycle) for the precoding scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices is an odd number in Embodiment 9. In this case, high data reception quality may be achieved even if the length of the period (cycle) pertaining to the present embodiment is reduced to approximately half of the length of the period (cycle) pertaining to Embodiment 9. This can reduce the number of precoding matrices to be prepared, which brings about the advantageous effect of reducing the scale of circuits for the transmission device and the reception device. The above advantageous effect can be enhanced with a transmission device that is provided with one encoder and distributes encoded data as shown in
Especially, when λ=0 radians and θ11=0 radians, the above equation can be expressed as follows.
In this case, i=0, 1, 2, . . . , n−2, n−1, n. Out of the n+1 different precoding matrices according to Equation #22 (namely, F[0], F[1], . . . , F[i], . . . , F[n−1], F[n]), F[0] is used once, and each of F[1] through F[n] is used twice (i.e., F[1] is used twice, F[2] is used twice, . . . , F[n−1] is used twice, and F[n] is used twice). As a result, the precoding scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices with an N-slot period (cycle) where N=2n+1 is achieved, and the reception device can achieve excellent data reception quality, similarly to the case where the number of slots in a period (cycle) for the precoding scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices is an odd number in Embodiment 9. In this case, high data reception quality may be achieved even if the length of the period (cycle) pertaining to the present embodiment is reduced to approximately half of the length of the period (cycle) pertaining to Embodiment 9. This can reduce the number of precoding matrices to be prepared, which brings about the advantageous effect of reducing the scale of circuits for the transmission device and the reception device.
Especially, when λ=π radians and θ11=0 radians, the following equation is true.
In this case, i=0, 1, 2, . . . , n−2, n−1, n. Out of the n+1 different precoding matrices according to Equation #23 (namely, F[0], F[1], . . . , F[i], . . . , F[n−1], F[n]), F[0] is used once, and each of F[1] through F[n] is used twice (i.e., F[1] is used twice, F[2] is used twice, . . . , F[n−1] is used twice, and F[n] is used twice). As a result, the precoding scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices with an N-slot period (cycle) where N=2n+1 is achieved, and the reception device can achieve excellent data reception quality, similarly to the case where the number of slots in a period (cycle) for the precoding scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices is an odd number in Embodiment 9. In this case, high data reception quality may be achieved even if the length of the period (cycle) pertaining to the present embodiment is reduced to approximately half of the length of the period (cycle) pertaining to Embodiment 9. This can reduce the number of precoding matrices to be prepared, which brings about the advantageous effect of reducing the scale of circuits for the transmission device and the reception device.
Furthermore, when a=1 as in the relationships shown in Equation #19 and Equation #20, Equation #21 can be expressed as follows.
In this case, i=0, 1, 2, . . . , n−2, n−1, n. Out of the n+1 different precoding matrices according to Equation #24 (namely, F[0], F[1], . . . , F[i], . . . , F[n−1], F[n]), F[0] is used once, and each of F[1] through F[n] is used twice (i.e., F[1] is used twice, F[2] is used twice, . . . , F[n−1] is used twice, and F[n] is used twice). As a result, the precoding scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices with an N-slot period (cycle) where N=2n+1 is achieved, and the reception device can achieve excellent data reception quality, similarly to the case where the number of slots in a period (cycle) for the precoding scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices is an odd number in Embodiment 9. In this case, high data reception quality may be achieved even if the length of the period (cycle) pertaining to the present embodiment is reduced to approximately half of the length of the period (cycle) pertaining to Embodiment 9. This can reduce the number of precoding matrices to be prepared, which brings about the advantageous effect of reducing the scale of circuits for the transmission device and the reception device.
Similarly, when a=1 in Equation #22, the following equation is true.
In this case, i=0, 1, 2, . . . , n−2, n−1, n. Out of the n+1 different precoding matrices according to Equation #25 (namely, F[0], F[1], . . . , F[i], . . . , F[n−1], F[n]), F[0] is used once, and each of F[1] through F[n] is used twice (i.e., F[1] is used twice, F[2] is used twice, . . . , F[n−1] is used twice, and F[n] is used twice). As a result, the precoding scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices with an N-slot period (cycle) where N=2n+1 is achieved, and the reception device can achieve excellent data reception quality, similarly to the case where the number of slots in a period (cycle) for the precoding scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices is an odd number in Embodiment 9. In this case, high data reception quality may be achieved even if the length of the period (cycle) pertaining to the present embodiment is reduced to approximately half of the length of the period (cycle) pertaining to Embodiment 9. This can reduce the number of precoding matrices to be prepared, which brings about the advantageous effect of reducing the scale of circuits for the transmission device and the reception device.
Similarly, when a=1 in Equation #23, the following equation is true.
In this case, i=0, 1, 2, . . . , n−2, n−1, n. Out of the n+1 different precoding matrices according to Equation #26 (namely, F[0], F[1], . . . , F[i], . . . , F[n−1], F[n]), F[0] is used once, and each of F[1] through F[n] is used twice (i.e., F[1] is used twice, F[2] is used twice, . . . , F[n−1] is used twice, and F[n] is used twice). As a result, the precoding scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices with an N-slot period (cycle) where N=2n+1 is achieved, and the reception device can achieve excellent data reception quality, similarly to the case where the number of slots in a period (cycle) for the precoding scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices is an odd number in Embodiment 9. In this case, high data reception quality may be achieved even if the length of the period (cycle) pertaining to the present embodiment is reduced to approximately half of the length of the period (cycle) pertaining to Embodiment 9. This can reduce the number of precoding matrices to be prepared, which brings about the advantageous effect of reducing the scale of circuits for the transmission device and the reception device.
A preferable example of a appearing in the above examples can be obtained by using any of the schemes described in Embodiment 18. However, α is not limited to being obtained in this way.
According to the present embodiment, in the case of a single-carrier transmission scheme, the precoding matrices W[0], W[1], . . . , W[2n−1], W[2n] (which are constituted by F[0], F[1], F[2], . . . , F[n−1], F[n]) for a precoding hopping scheme with a an N-slot period (cycle) where N=2n+1 (i.e., a precoding scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices with an N-slot period (cycle) where N=2n+1) are arranged in the order W[0], W[1], . . . , W[2n−1], W[2n] in the time domain (or the frequency domain). The present invention is not, however, limited in this way, and the precoding matrices W[0], W[1], . . . , W[2n−1], W[2n] may be applied to a multi-carrier transmission scheme such as an OFDM transmission scheme or the like. As in Embodiment 1, as a scheme of adaption in this case, precoding weights may be changed by arranging symbols in the frequency domain and in the frequency-time domain. Although the above has described the precoding hopping scheme with an N-slot period (cycle) where N=2n+1, the same advantageous effects may be obtained by randomly using W[0], W[1], . . . , W[2n−1], W[2n]. In other words, W[0], W[1], . . . , W[2n−1], W[2n] do not necessarily need to be used in a regular period (cycle).
Furthermore, in the precoding matrix hopping scheme over an H-slot period (cycle) (H being a natural number larger than the number of slots N=2n+1 in the period (cycle) of the above scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices), when the N different precoding matrices of the present embodiment are included, the probability of excellent reception quality increases.
The present embodiment provides detailed descriptions of a case where, as shown in Non-Patent Literature 12 through Non-Patent Literature 15, a Quasi-Cyclic Low-Density Parity-Check (QC-LDPC) code (or an LDPC (block) code other than a QC-LDPC code) and a block code (e.g., a concatenated code consisting of an LDPC code and a Bose-Chaudhuri-Hocquenghem (BCH) code, and a turbo code) are used, especially when the scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices described in Embodiments 16 through 26 and C1 is employed. This embodiment describes an example of transmitting two streams, s1 and s2. However, for the case of coding using block codes, when control information or the like is not necessary, the number of bits in a coded block matches the number of bits composing the block code (the control information or the like listed below may, however, be included therein). For the case of coding using block codes, when control information or the like (such as a cyclic redundancy check (CRC), transmission parameters, or the like) is necessary, the number of bits in a coded block is the sum of the number of bits composing the block code and the number of bits in the control information or the like.
As shown in
Since the transmission device in
By similar reasoning, when the modulation scheme is 16QAM, 750 slots are necessary to transmit all of the bits constituting one coded block, and when the modulation scheme is 64QAM, 500 slots are necessary to transmit all of the bits constituting one block.
The following describes the relationship between the slots defined above and the precoding matrices in the scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices.
Here, the number of precoding matrices prepared for the scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices is set to five. In other words, five different precoding matrices are prepared for the weighting unit in the transmission device in
When the modulation scheme is QPSK, among the 1,500 slots described above for transmitting the 6,000 bits constituting one coded block, it is necessary for 300 slots to use the precoding matrix F[0], 300 slots to use the precoding matrix F[1], 300 slots to use the precoding matrix F[2], 300 slots to use the precoding matrix F[3], and 300 slots to use the precoding matrix F[4]. This is because if use of the precoding matrices is biased, the reception quality of data is greatly influenced by the precoding matrix that was used a greater number of times.
When the modulation scheme is 16QAM, among the 750 slots described above for transmitting the 6,000 bits constituting one coded block, it is necessary for 150 slots to use the precoding matrix F[0], 150 slots to use the precoding matrix F[1], 150 slots to use the precoding matrix F[2], 150 slots to use the precoding matrix F[3], and 150 slots to use the precoding matrix F[4].
When the modulation scheme is 64QAM, among the 500 slots described above for transmitting the 6,000 bits constituting one coded block, it is necessary for 100 slots to use the precoding matrix F[0], 100 slots to use the precoding matrix F[1], 100 slots to use the precoding matrix F[2], 100 slots to use the precoding matrix F[3], and 100 slots to use the precoding matrix F[4].
As described above, in the scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices, if there are N different precoding matrices (represented as F[0], F[1], F[2], . . . , F[N−2], and F[N−1]), when transmitting all of the bits constituting one coded block, Condition #107 should be satisfied, wherein K0 is the number of slots using the precoding matrix F[0], K1 is the number of slots using the precoding matrix F[1], K1 is the number of slots using the precoding matrix F[i] (i=0, 1, 2, . . . , N−1), and KN-1 is the number of slots using the precoding matrix F[N−1].
K0=K1= . . . =Ki= . . . =KN-1, i.e. Ka=Kb(for ∀a,∀b, where a,b,=0,1,2, . . . ,N−1 (each of a and b being an integer in a range of 0 to N−1), and a≠b). Condition #107
If the communications system supports a plurality of modulation schemes, and the modulation scheme that is used is selected from among the supported modulation schemes, then a modulation scheme for which Condition #107 is satisfied should be selected.
When a plurality of modulation schemes are supported, it is typical for the number of bits that can be transmitted in one symbol to vary from modulation scheme to modulation scheme (although it is also possible for the number of bits to be the same), and therefore some modulation schemes may not be capable of satisfying Condition #107. In such a case, instead of Condition #107, the following condition should be satisfied.
The difference between Ka and Kb is 0 or 1, i.e. |Ka−Kb| is 0 or 1 (for ∀a,∀b, where a,b,=0,1,2, . . . ,N−1 (each of a and b being an integer in a range of 0 to N−1), and a≠b). Condition #108
As shown in
The transmission device in
By similar reasoning, when the modulation scheme is 16QAM, 1,500 slots are necessary to transmit all of the bits constituting two coded blocks, and when the modulation scheme is 64QAM, 1,000 slots are necessary to transmit all of the bits constituting two blocks.
The following describes the relationship between the slots defined above and the precoding matrices in the scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices.
Here, the number of precoding matrices prepared for the scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices is set to five. In other words, five different precoding matrices are prepared for the weighting unit in the transmission device in
When the modulation scheme is QPSK, among the 3,000 slots described above for transmitting the 6,000×2 bits constituting two coded blocks, it is necessary for 600 slots to use the precoding matrix F[0], 600 slots to use the precoding matrix F[1], 600 slots to use the precoding matrix F[2], 600 slots to use the precoding matrix F[3], and 600 slots to use the precoding matrix F[4]. This is because if use of the precoding matrices is biased, the reception quality of data is greatly influenced by the precoding matrix that was used a greater number of times.
To transmit the first coded block, it is necessary for the slot using the precoding matrix F[0] to occur 600 times, the slot using the precoding matrix F[1] to occur 600 times, the slot using the precoding matrix F[2] to occur 600 times, the slot using the precoding matrix F[3] to occur 600 times, and the slot using the precoding matrix F[4] to occur 600 times. To transmit the second coded block, the slot using the precoding matrix F[0] should occur 600 times, the slot using the precoding matrix F[1] should occur 600 times, the slot using the precoding matrix F[2] should occur 600 times, the slot using the precoding matrix F[3] should occur 600 times, and the slot using the precoding matrix F[4] should occur 600 times.
Similarly, when the modulation scheme is 16QAM, among the 1,500 slots described above for transmitting the 6,000×2 bits constituting two coded blocks, it is necessary for 300 slots to use the precoding matrix F[0], 300 slots to use the precoding matrix F[1], 300 slots to use the precoding matrix F[2], 300 slots to use the precoding matrix F[3], and 300 slots to use the precoding matrix F[4].
To transmit the first coded block, it is necessary for the slot using the precoding matrix F[0] to occur 300 times, the slot using the precoding matrix F[1] to occur 300 times, the slot using the precoding matrix F[2] to occur 300 times, the slot using the precoding matrix F[3] to occur 300 times, and the slot using the precoding matrix F[4] to occur 300 times. To transmit the second coded block, the slot using the precoding matrix F[0] should occur 300 times, the slot using the precoding matrix F[1] should occur 300 times, the slot using the precoding matrix F[2] should occur 300 times, the slot using the precoding matrix F[3] should occur 300 times, and the slot using the precoding matrix F[4] should occur 300 times.
Similarly, when the modulation scheme is 64QAM, among the 1,000 slots described above for transmitting the 6,000×2 bits constituting two coded blocks, it is necessary for 200 slots to use the precoding matrix F[0], 200 slots to use the precoding matrix F[1], 200 slots to use the precoding matrix F[2], 200 slots to use the precoding matrix F[3], and 200 slots to use the precoding matrix F[4].
To transmit the first coded block, it is necessary for the slot using the precoding matrix F[0] to occur 200 times, the slot using the precoding matrix F[1] to occur 200 times, the slot using the precoding matrix F[2] to occur 200 times, the slot using the precoding matrix F[3] to occur 200 times, and the slot using the precoding matrix F[4] to occur 200 times. To transmit the second coded block, the slot using the precoding matrix F[0] should occur 200 times, the slot using the precoding matrix F[1] should occur 200 times, the slot using the precoding matrix F[2] should occur 200 times, the slot using the precoding matrix F[3] should occur 200 times, and the slot using the precoding matrix F[4] should occur 200 times.
As described above, in the scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices, if there are N different precoding matrices (represented as F[0], F[1], F[2], . . . , F[N−2], and F[N−1]), when transmitting all of the bits constituting two coded blocks, Condition #109 should be satisfied, wherein K0 is the number of slots using the precoding matrix F[0], K1 is the number of slots using the precoding matrix F[1], Ki is the number of slots using the precoding matrix F[i] (i=0, 1, 2, . . . , N−1), and KN-1 is the number of slots using the precoding matrix F[N−1].
K0=K1= . . . =Ki= . . . =KN-1, i.e. Ka=Kb(for ∀a,∀b, where a,b,=0,1,2, . . . ,N−1 (each of a and b being an integer in a range of 0 to N−1), and a≠b). Condition #109
When transmitting all of the bits constituting the first coded block, Condition #110 should be satisfied, wherein K0,1 is the number of times the precoding matrix F[0] is used, K1,1 is the number of times the precoding matrix F[1] is used, Ki,1 is the number of times the precoding matrix F[i] is used (i=0, 1, 2, . . . , N−1), and KN-1,1 is the number of times the precoding matrix F[N−1] is used.
K0,1=K1,1= . . . =Ki,1= . . . =KN-1,1, i.e. Ka,1=Kb,1 (for ∀a,∀b, where a,b,=0,1,2, . . . ,N−1 (each of a and b being an integer in a range of 0 to N−1), and a≠b). Condition #110
When transmitting all of the bits constituting the second coded block, Condition #111 should be satisfied, wherein K0,2 is the number of times the precoding matrix F[0] is used, K1,2 is the number of times the precoding matrix F[1] is used, Ki,2 is the number of times the precoding matrix F[i] is used (i=0, 1, 2, . . . , N−1), and KN-1,2 is the number of times the precoding matrix F[N−1] is used.
K0,2=K1,2= . . . =Ki,2= . . . =KN-1,2, i.e. Ka,2=Kb,2(for ∀a,∀b, where a,b,=0,1,2, . . . ,N−1 (each of a and b being an integer in a range of 0 to N−1), and a≠b). Condition #111
If the communications system supports a plurality of modulation schemes, and the modulation scheme that is used is selected from among the supported modulation schemes, the selected modulation scheme preferably satisfies Conditions #109, #110, and #111.
When a plurality of modulation schemes are supported, it is typical for the number of bits that can be transmitted in one symbol to vary from modulation scheme to modulation scheme (although it is also possible for the number of bits to be the same), and therefore some modulation schemes may not be capable of satisfying Conditions #109, #110, and #111. In such a case, instead of Conditions #109, #110, and #111, the following conditions should be satisfied.
The difference between Ka and Kb is 0 or 1, i.e. |Ka−Kb| is 0 or 1 (for ∀a,∀b, where a,b,=0,1,2, . . . ,N−1 (each of a and b being an integer in a range of 0 to N−1), and a≠b). Condition #112
The difference between Ka,1and Kb,1 is 0 or 1, i.e. |Ka,1−Kb,1| is 0 or 1 (for ∀a,∀b, where a,b,=0,1,2, . . . ,N−1 (each of a and b being an integer in a range of 0 to N−1), and a≠b). Condition #113
The difference between Ka,2and Kb,2 is 0 or 1, i.e. |Ka,2−Kb,2| is 0 or 1 (for ∀a,∀b, where a,b,=0,1,2, . . . ,N−1 (each of a and b being an integer in a range of 0 to N−1), and a≠b). Condition #114
Associating coded blocks with precoding matrices in this way eliminates bias in the precoding matrices that are used for transmitting coded blocks, thereby achieving the advantageous effect of improving reception quality of data by the reception device.
In the present embodiment, in the scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices, N different precoding matrices are necessary for a precoding hopping scheme with an N-slot period (cycle). In this case, F[0], F[1], F[2], . . . , F[N−2], F[N−1] are prepared as the N different precoding matrices. These precoding matrices may be arranged in the frequency domain in the order of F[0], F[1], F[2], . . . , F[N−2], F[N−1], but arrangement is not limited in this way. With N different precoding matrices F[0], F[1], F[2], . . . , F[N−2], F[N−1] generated in the present Embodiment, precoding weights may be changed by arranging symbols in the time domain or in the frequency-time domains as in Embodiment 1. Note that a precoding hopping scheme with an N-slot period (cycle) has been described, but the same advantageous effects may be obtained by randomly using N different precoding matrices. In other words, the N different precoding matrices do not necessarily need to be used in a regular period (cycle). Here, when the conditions provided in the present embodiment are satisfied, the reception device has a high possibility of achieving excellent data reception quality.
Furthermore, as described in Embodiment 15, a spatial multiplexing MIMO system, a MIMO system in which precoding matrices are fixed, a space-time block coding scheme, a one-stream-only transmission mode, and modes for schemes of regularly hopping between precoding matrices may exist, and the transmission device (broadcast station, base station) may select the transmission scheme from among these modes. In this case, in the spatial multiplexing MIMO system, the MIMO system in which precoding matrices are fixed, the space-time block coding scheme, the one-stream-only transmission mode, and the modes for schemes of regularly hopping between precoding matrices, it is preferable to implement the present embodiment in the (sub)carriers for which a scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices is selected.
The present embodiment provides detailed descriptions of a case where, as shown in Non-Patent Literature 12 through Non-Patent Literature 15, a QC-LDPC code (or an LDPC (block) code other than a QC-LDPC code) and a block code (e.g., a concatenated code consisting of an LDPC code and a BCH code, and a turbo code) are used, especially when the scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices described in Embodiments C2 is employed. This embodiment describes an example of transmitting two streams, s1 and s2. However, for the case of coding using block codes, when control information or the like is not necessary, the number of bits in a coded block matches the number of bits composing the block code (the control information or the like listed below may, however, be included therein). For the case of coding using block codes, when control information or the like (such as a cyclic redundancy check (CRC), transmission parameters, or the like) is necessary, the number of bits in a coded block is the sum of the number of bits composing the block code and the number of bits in the control information or the like.
As shown in
By similar reasoning, when the modulation scheme is 16QAM, 750 slots are necessary to transmit all of the bits constituting one coded block, and when the modulation scheme is 64QAM, 500 slots are necessary to transmit all of the bits constituting one block.
The following describes the relationship between the slots defined above and the precoding matrices in the scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices.
Here, five precoding matrices for realizing the precoding scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices with a five-slot period (cycle), as described in Embodiment C2, are expressed as W[0], W[1], W[2], W[3], and W[4] (the weighting unit of the transmission device selects one of a plurality of precoding matrices and performs precoding for each slot).
When the modulation scheme is QPSK, among the 1,500 slots described above for transmitting the 6,000 bits constituting one coded block, it is necessary for 300 slots to use the precoding matrix W[0], 300 slots to use the precoding matrix W[1], 300 slots to use the precoding matrix W[2], 300 slots to use the precoding matrix W[3], and 300 slots to use the precoding matrix W[4]. This is because if use of the precoding matrices is biased, the reception quality of data is greatly influenced by the precoding matrix that was used a greater number of times.
When the modulation scheme is 16QAM, among the 750 slots described above for transmitting the 6,000 bits constituting one coded block, it is necessary for 150 slots to use the precoding matrix W[0], 150 slots to use the precoding matrix W[1], 150 slots to use the precoding matrix W[2], 150 slots to use the precoding matrix W[3], and 150 slots to use the precoding matrix W[4].
When the modulation scheme is 64QAM, among the 500 slots described above for transmitting the 6,000 bits constituting one coded block, it is necessary for 100 slots to use the precoding matrix W[0], 100 slots to use the precoding matrix W[1], 100 slots to use the precoding matrix W[2], 100 slots to use the precoding matrix W[3], and 100 slots to use the precoding matrix W[4].
As described above, in the scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices pertaining to Embodiment C2, provided that the precoding matrices W[0], W[1], . . . , W[2n−1], and W[2n] (which are constituted by F[0], F[1], F[2], . . . , F[n−1], and F[n]; see Embodiment C2) are prepared to achieve an N-slot period (cycle) where N=2n+1, when transmitting all of the bits constituting one coded block, Condition #115 should be satisfied, wherein K0 is the number of slots using the precoding matrix W[0], K1 is the number of slots using the precoding matrix W[1], Ki is the number of slots using the precoding matrix W[i] (i=0, 1, 2, . . . , 2n−1, 2n), and K2n is the number of slots using the precoding matrix W[2n].
K0=K1= . . . =Ki= . . . =K2n, i.e. Ka=Kb (for ∀a,∀b, where a,b,=0,1,2, . . . ,2n−1,2n (each of a and b being an integer in a range of 0 to 2n), and a≠b). Condition #115
In the scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices pertaining to Embodiment C2, provided that the different precoding matrices F[0], F[1], F[2], . . . , F[n−1], and F[n] are prepared to achieve an N-slot period (cycle) where N=2n+1, when transmitting all of the bits constituting one coded block, Condition #115 can be expressed as follows, wherein G0 is the number of slots using the precoding matrix F[0], G1 is the number of slots using the precoding matrix F[1], Gi is the number of slots using the precoding matrix F[i] (i=0, 1, 2, . . . , n−1, n), and Gn is the number of slots using the precoding matrix F[n].
2×G0=G1= . . . =Gi= . . . =Gn, i.e. 2×G0=Ga (for ∀a, where a=1,2, . . . ,n−1,n(a being an integer in a range of 1to n)). Condition #116
If the communications system supports a plurality of modulation schemes, and the modulation scheme that is used is selected from among the supported modulation schemes, then a modulation scheme for which Condition #115 (#116) is satisfied should be selected.
When a plurality of modulation schemes are supported, it is typical for the number of bits that can be transmitted in one symbol to vary from modulation scheme to modulation scheme (although it is also possible for the number of bits to be the same), and therefore some modulation schemes may not be capable of satisfying Condition #115 (#116). In such a case, instead of Condition #115, the following condition should be satisfied.
The difference between Ka and Kb is 0 or 1, i.e. |Ka−Kb| is 0 or 1 (for ∀a,∀b, where a,b,=0,1,2, . . . ,2n−1,2n (each of a and b being an integer in a range of 0 to 2n), and a≠b). Condition #117
Condition #117 can also be expressed as follows.
The difference between Ga and Gb is 0,1 or 2, i.e. |Ga−Gb| is 0,1 or 2 (for ∀a,∀b, where a,b,=1,2, . . . ,n−1,n (each of a and b being an integer in a range of 1to n), and a≠b); and
the difference between 2×G0 and Ga is 0,1 or 2, i.e. |2×G0−Ga| is 0,1 or 2 (for ∀a, where a=1,2, . . . ,n−1,n (a being an integer in a range of 1to n)). Condition #118
The transmission device in
By similar reasoning, when the modulation scheme is 16QAM, 1,500 slots are necessary to transmit all of the bits constituting two coded blocks, and when the modulation scheme is 64QAM, 1,000 slots are necessary to transmit all of the bits constituting two blocks.
The following describes the relationship between the slots defined above and the precoding matrices in the scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices.
Below, the five precoding matrices prepared in Embodiment C2 to implement the precoding scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices with a five-slot period (cycle) are expressed as W[0], W[1], W[2], W[3], and W[4]. (The weighting unit in the transmission device selects one of a plurality of precoding matrices and performs precoding for each slot).
When the modulation scheme is QPSK, among the 3,000 slots described above for transmitting the 6,000×2 bits constituting two coded blocks, it is necessary for 600 slots to use the precoding matrix W[0], 600 slots to use the precoding matrix W[1], 600 slots to use the precoding matrix W[2], 600 slots to use the precoding matrix W[3], and 600 slots to use the precoding matrix W[4]. This is because if use of the precoding matrices is biased, the reception quality of data is greatly influenced by the precoding matrix that was used a greater number of times.
To transmit the first coded block, it is necessary for the slot using the precoding matrix W[0] to occur 600 times, the slot using the precoding matrix W[1] to occur 600 times, the slot using the precoding matrix W[2] to occur 600 times, the slot using the precoding matrix W[3] to occur 600 times, and the slot using the precoding matrix W[4] to occur 600 times. To transmit the second coded block, the slot using the precoding matrix W[0] should occur 600 times, the slot using the precoding matrix W[1] should occur 600 times, the slot using the precoding matrix W[2] should occur 600 times, the slot using the precoding matrix W[3] should occur 600 times, and the slot using the precoding matrix W[4] should occur 600 times.
Similarly, when the modulation scheme is 16QAM, among the 1,500 slots described above for transmitting the 6,000×2 bits constituting two coded blocks, it is necessary for 300 slots to use the precoding matrix W[0], 300 slots to use the precoding matrix W[1], 300 slots to use the precoding matrix W[2], 300 slots to use the precoding matrix W[3], and 300 slots to use the precoding matrix W[4].
To transmit the first coded block, it is necessary for the slot using the precoding matrix W[0] to occur 300 times, the slot using the precoding matrix W[1] to occur 300 times, the slot using the precoding matrix W[2] to occur 300 times, the slot using the precoding matrix W[3] to occur 300 times, and the slot using the precoding matrix W[4] to occur 300 times. To transmit the second coded block, the slot using the precoding matrix W[0] should occur 300 times, the slot using the precoding matrix W[1] should occur 300 times, the slot using the precoding matrix W[2] should occur 300 times, the slot using the precoding matrix W[3] should occur 300 times, and the slot using the precoding matrix W[4] should occur 300 times.
Similarly, when the modulation scheme is 64QAM, among the 1,000 slots described above for transmitting the 6,000×2 bits constituting two coded blocks, it is necessary for 200 slots to use the precoding matrix W[0], 200 slots to use the precoding matrix W[1], 200 slots to use the precoding matrix W[2], 200 slots to use the precoding matrix W[3], and 200 slots to use the precoding matrix W[4].
To transmit the first coded block, it is necessary for the slot using the precoding matrix W[0] to occur 200 times, the slot using the precoding matrix W[1] to occur 200 times, the slot using the precoding matrix W[2] to occur 200 times, the slot using the precoding matrix W[3] to occur 200 times, and the slot using the precoding matrix W[4] to occur 200 times. To transmit the second coded block, the slot using the precoding matrix W[0] should occur 200 times, the slot using the precoding matrix W[1] should occur 200 times, the slot using the precoding matrix W[2] should occur 200 times, the slot using the precoding matrix W[3] should occur 200 times, and the slot using the precoding matrix W[4] should occur 200 times.
As described above, in the scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices pertaining to Embodiment C2, provided that the precoding matrices W[0], W[1], . . . , W[2n−1], and W[2n] (which are constituted by F[0], F[1], F[2], . . . , F[n−1], and F[n]; see Embodiment C2) are prepared to achieve an N-slot period (cycle) where N=2n+1, when transmitting all of the bits constituting two coded blocks, Condition #119 should be satisfied, wherein K0 is the number of slots using the precoding matrix W[0], K1 is the number of slots using the precoding matrix W[1], Ki is the number of slots using the precoding matrix W[i] (i=0, 1, 2, . . . , 2n−1, 2n), and K2n is the number of slots using the precoding matrix W[2n].
K0=K1= . . . =Ki= . . . =K2n, i.e. Ka=Kb (for ∀a,∀b, where a,b,=0,1,2, . . . ,2n−1,2n (each of a and b being an integer in a range of 0 to 2n), and a≠b). Condition #119
When transmitting all of the bits constituting the first coded block, Condition #120 should be satisfied, wherein K0,1 is the number of times the precoding matrix W[0] is used, K1,1 is the number of times the precoding matrix W[1] is used, Ki,1 is the number of times the precoding matrix W[i] is used (i=0, 1, 2, . . . , 2n−1, 2n), and K2n,1 is the number of times the precoding matrix W[2n] is used.
K0,1=K1,1= . . . =Ki,1= . . . =K2n,1, i.e. Ka,1=Kb,1 (for ∀a,∀b, where a,b,=0,1,2, . . . ,2n−1,2n (each of a and b being an integer in a range of 0 to 2n), and a≠b). Condition #120
When transmitting all of the bits constituting the second coded block, Condition #121 should be satisfied, wherein K0,2 is the number of times the precoding matrix W[0] is used, K1,2 is the number of times the precoding matrix W[1] is used, Ki,2 is the number of times the precoding matrix W[i] is used (i=0, 1, 2, . . . , 2n−1, 2n), and K2n,2 is the number of times the precoding matrix W[2n] is used.
K0,2=K1,2= . . . =Ki,2= . . . =K2n,2, i.e. Ka,2=Kb,2 (for ∀a,∀b, where a,b,=0,1,2, . . . ,2n−1,2n (each of a and b being an integer in a range of 0 to 2n), and a≠b). Condition #121
In the scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices pertaining to Embodiment C2, provided that the different precoding matrices F[0], F[1], F[2], . . . , F[n−1], and F[n] are prepared to achieve an N-slot period (cycle) where N=2n+1, when transmitting all of the bits constituting two coded blocks, Condition #119 can be expressed as follows, wherein G0 is the number of slots using the precoding matrix F[0], G1 is the number of slots using the precoding matrix F[1], Gi is the number of slots using the precoding matrix F[i] (i=0, 1, 2, . . . , n−1, n), and Gn is the number of slots using the precoding matrix F[n].
2×G0=G1= . . . =Gi= . . . =Gn, i.e. 2×G0=Ga (for ∀a, where a=1,2, . . . ,n−1,n (a being an integer in a range of 1to n)). Condition #122
When transmitting all of the bits constituting the first coded block, Condition #123 should be satisfied, wherein G0,1 is the number of times the precoding matrix F[0] is used, K1,1 is the number of times the precoding matrix F[1] is used, Gi,1 is the number of times the precoding matrix F[i] is used (i=0, 1, 2, . . . , n−1, n), and Gn,1 is the number of times the precoding matrix F[n] is used.
2×G0,1=G1,1= . . . =Gi,1= . . . =Gn,1, i.e. 2×G0,1=Ga,1 (for ∀a, where a=1,2, . . . ,n−1,n (a being an integer in a range of 1to n)). Condition #123
When transmitting all of the bits constituting the second coded block, Condition #124 should be satisfied, wherein G0,2 is the number of times the precoding matrix F[0] is used, G1,2 is the number of times the precoding matrix F[1] is used, Gi,2 is the number of times the precoding matrix F[i] is used (i=0, 1, 2, . . . , n−1, n), and Gn,2 is the number of times the precoding matrix F[n] is used.
2×G0,2=G1,2= . . . =Gi,2= . . . =Gn,2, i.e. 2×G0,2=Ga,2 (for ∀a, where a=1,2, . . . ,n−1,n (a being an integer in a range of 1to n)). Condition #124
If the communications system supports a plurality of modulation schemes, and the modulation scheme that is used is selected from among the supported modulation schemes, then a modulation scheme for which Conditions #119, #120 and #121 (#122, #123 and #124) are satisfied should be selected. When a plurality of modulation schemes are supported, it is typical for the number of bits that can be transmitted in one symbol to vary from modulation scheme to modulation scheme (although it is also possible for the number of bits to be the same), and therefore some modulation schemes may not be capable of satisfying Conditions #119, #120, and #121 (#122, #123 and #124). In such a case, instead of Conditions #119, #120, and #121, the following conditions should be satisfied.
The difference between Ka and Kb is 0 or 1, i.e. |Ka−Kb| is 0 or 1 (for ∀a,∀b, where a,b,=0,1,2, . . . ,2n−1,2n (each of a and b being an integer in a range of 0 to 2n), and a≠b). Condition #125
The difference between Ka,1 and Kb,1 is 0 or 1, i.e. |Ka,1−Kb,1| is 0 or 1 (for ∀a,∀b, where a,b,=0,1,2, . . . ,2n−1,2n (each of a and b being an integer in a range of 0 to 2n), and a≠b). Condition #126
The difference between Ka,2 and Kb,2 is 0 or 1, i.e. |Ka,2−Kb,2| is 0 or 1 (for ∀a,∀b, where a,b,=0,1,2, . . . ,2n−1,2n (each of a and b being an integer in a range of 0 to 2n), and a≠b). Condition #127
Conditions #125, #126 and #127 can also be expressed as follows.
The difference between Ga and Gb is 0,1 or 2, i.e. |Ga−Gb| is 0,1 or 2 (for ∀a,∀b, where a,b,=1,2, . . . ,n−1,n (each of a and b being an integer in a range of 1to n), and a≠b); and
the difference between 2×G0 and Ga is 0,1 or 2, i.e. |2×G0−Ga| is 0,1 or 2 (for ∀a, where a=1,2, . . . ,n−1,n (a being an integer in a range of 1to n)). Condition #128
The difference between Ga,1 and Gb,1 is 0,1 or 2, i.e. |Ga,1−Gb,1| is 0,1 or 2 (for ∀a,∀b, where a,b,=1,2, . . . ,n−1,n (each of a and b being an integer in a range of 1to n), and a≠b); and
the difference between 2×G0,1 and Ga,1 is 0,1 or 2, i.e. |2×G0,1−Ga,1| is 0,1 or 2 (for ∀a, where a=1,2, . . . ,n−1,n (a being an integer in a range of 1to n)). Condition #129
The difference between Ga,2 and Gb,2 is 0,1 or 2, i.e. |Ga,2−Gb,2| is 0,1 or 2 (for ∀a,∀b, where a,b,=1,2, . . . ,n−1,n (each of a and b being an integer in a range of 1to n), and a≠b); and
the difference between 2×G0,2 and Ga,2 is 0,1 or 2, i.e. |2×G0,2−Ga,2| is 0,1 or 2 (for ∀a, where a=1,2, . . . ,n−1,n (a being an integer in a range of 1to n)). Condition #130
Associating coded blocks with precoding matrices in this way eliminates bias in the precoding matrices that are used for transmitting coded blocks, thereby achieving the advantageous effect of improving reception quality of data by the reception device.
In the present embodiment, precoding matrices W[0], W[1], . . . , W[2n−1], W[2n] (note that W[0], W[1], W[2n−1], W[2n] are composed of F[0], F[1], F[2], . . . , F[n−1], F[n]) for the precoding hopping scheme with the period (cycle) of N=2n+1 slots as described in Embodiment C2 (the precoding scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices with the period (cycle) of N=2n+1 slots) are arranged in the order W[0], W[1], . . . , W[2n−1], W[2] in the time domain (or the frequency domain) in the single carrier transmission scheme. The present invention is not, however, limited in this way, and the precoding matrices W[0], W[1], . . . , W[2n−1], W[2n] may be adapted to a multi-carrier transmission scheme such as an OFDM transmission scheme or the like. As in Embodiment 1, as a scheme of adaption in this case, precoding weights may be changed by arranging symbols in the frequency domain and in the frequency-time domain. Note that the precoding hopping scheme with the period (cycle) of N=2n+1 slots has been described, but the same advantageous effect may be obtained by randomly using the precoding matrices W[0], W[1], . . . , W[2n−1], W[2n]. In other words, the precoding matrices W[0], W[1], . . . , W[2n−1], W[2n] do not need to be used in a regular period (cycle). In this case, when the conditions described in the present embodiment are satisfied, the probability that the reception device achieves excellent data reception quality is high.
Furthermore, in the precoding matrix hopping scheme with an H-slot period (cycle) (H being a natural number larger than the number of slots N=2n+1 in the period (cycle) of the above-mentioned scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices), when n+1 different precoding matrices of the present embodiment are included, the probability of providing excellent reception quality increases.
As described in Embodiment 15, there are modes such as the spatial multiplexing MIMO system, the MIMO system with a fixed precoding matrix, the space-time block coding scheme, the scheme of transmitting one stream and the scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices. The transmission device (broadcast station, base station) may select one transmission scheme from among these modes. In this case, from among the spatial multiplexing MIMO system, the MIMO system with a fixed precoding matrix, the space-time block coding scheme, the scheme of transmitting one stream and the scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices, a (sub)carrier group selecting the scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices may implement the present embodiment.
As shown in Non-Patent Literature 12 through Non-Patent Literature 15, the present embodiment describes a case where Embodiment C3 and Embodiment C4 are generalized when using a Quasi-Cyclic Low-Density Parity-Check (QC-LDPC) code (or an LDPC (block) code other than a QC-LDPC code), a block code such as a concatenated code consisting of an LDPC code and a Bose-Chaudhuri-Hocquenghem (BCH) code, and a block code such as a turbo code. The following describes a case of transmitting two streams s1 and s2 as an example. Note that, when the control information and the like are not required to perform encoding using the block code, the number of bits constituting the coded block is the same as the number of bits constituting the block code (however, the control information and the like described below may be included). When the control information and the like (e.g. CRC (cyclic redundancy check), a transmission parameter) are required to perform encoding using the block code, the number of bits constituting the coded block can be a sum of the number of bits constituting the block code and the number of bits of the control information and the like.
As shown in
Since two streams are to be simultaneously transmitted in the transmission device shown in
The following describes the relationship between the slots defined above and precoding matrices in the scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices.
Here, let the precoding matrices for the scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices with a five-slot period (cycle) be W[0], W[1], W[2], W[3], W[4]. Note that at least two or more different precoding matrices may be included in W[0], W[1], W[2], W[3], W[4] (the same precoding matrices may be included in W[0], W[1], W[2], W[3], W[4]). In the weighting combination unit of the transmission device in
Out of the above-mentioned 1500 slots required to transmit 6000 bits, which is the number of bits constituting one coded block, when the modulation scheme is QPSK, 300 slots are necessary for each of a slot using the precoding matrix W[0], a slot using the precoding matrix W[1], a slot using the precoding matrix W[2], a slot using the precoding matrix W[3] and a slot using the precoding matrix W[4]. This is because, if precoding matrices to be used are biased, data reception quality is greatly influenced by a large number of precoding matrices to be used.
Similarly, out of the above-mentioned 750 slots required to transmit 6000 bits, which is the number of bits constituting one coded block, when the modulation scheme is 16QAM, 150 slots are necessary for each of the slot using the precoding matrix W[0], the slot using the precoding matrix W[1], the slot using the precoding matrix W[2], the slot using the precoding matrix W[3] and the slot using the precoding matrix W[4].
Similarly, out of the above-mentioned 500 slots required to transmit 6000 bits, which is the number of bits constituting one coded block, when the modulation scheme is 64QAM, 100 slots are necessary for each of the slot using the precoding matrix W[0], the slot using the precoding matrix W[1], the slot using the precoding matrix W[2], the slot using the precoding matrix W[3] and the slot using the precoding matrix W[4].
As described above, the precoding matrices in the scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices with an N-slot period (cycle) are represented as W[0], W[1], W[2], . . . , W[N−2], W[N−1].
Note that W[0], W[1], W[2], . . . , W[N−2], W[N−1] are composed of at least two or more different precoding matrices (the same precoding matrices may be included in W[0], W[1], W[2], . . . , W[N−2], W[N−1]). When all the bits constituting one coded block are transmitted, letting the number of slots using the precoding matrix W[0] be K0, letting the number of slots using the precoding matrix W[1] be K1, letting the number of slots using the precoding matrix W[i] be Ki (i=0, 1, 2, . . . , N−1), and letting the number of slots using the precoding matrix W[N−1] be KN-1, the following condition should be satisfied.
K0=K1= . . . =Ki= . . . =KN-1, i.e., Ka=Kb for ∀a,∀b (a,b=0,1,2, . . . ,N−1 (a,b are integers from 0 to N−1);a≠b) Condition #131
When the communication system supports a plurality of modulation schemes, and a modulation scheme is selected and used from among the supported modulation schemes, Condition #94 should be satisfied.
When the plurality of modulation schemes are supported, however, since the number of bits that one symbol can transmit is generally different depending on modulation schemes (in some cases, the number of bits can be the same), there can be a modulation scheme that is not able to satisfy Condition #131. In such a case, instead of satisfying Condition #131, the following condition may be satisfied.
The difference between Ka and Kb is 0 or 1, i.e., |Ka−Kb| is 0 or 1for ∀a,∀b (a,b=0,1,2, . . . ,N−1 (a,b are integers from 0 to N−1);a≠b) Condition #132
As shown in
Since two streams are to be simultaneously transmitted in the transmission device shown in
Making the same considerations, 1500 slots are necessary to transmit all the bits constituting two coded blocks when the modulation scheme is 16QAM, and 1000 slots are necessary to transmit all the bits constituting 22 blocks when the modulation scheme is 64QAM.
The following describes the relationship between the slots defined above and precoding matrices in the scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices.
Here, let the precoding matrices for the scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices with a five-slot period (cycle) be W[0], W[1], W[2], W[3], W[4]. Note that at least two or more different precoding matrices may be included in W[0], W[1], W[2], W[3], W[4] (the same precoding matrices may be included in W[0], W[1], W[2], W[3], W[4]). In the weighting combination unit of the transmission device in
Out of the above-mentioned 3000 slots required to transmit 6000×2 bits, which is the number of bits constituting two coded blocks, when the modulation scheme is QPSK, 600 slots are necessary for each of the slot using the precoding matrix W[0], the slot using the precoding matrix W[1], the slot using the precoding matrix W[2], the slot using the precoding matrix W[3] and the slot using the precoding matrix W[4]. This is because, if precoding matrices to be used are biased, data reception quality is greatly influenced by a large number of precoding matrices to be used.
Also, in order to transmit the first coded block, 600 slots are necessary for each of the slot using the precoding matrix W[0], the slot using the precoding matrix W[1], the slot using the precoding matrix W[2], the slot using the precoding matrix W[3] and the slot using the precoding matrix W[4]. In order to transmit the second coded block, 600 slots are necessary for each of the slot using the precoding matrix W[0], the slot using the precoding matrix W[1], the slot using the precoding matrix W[2], the slot using the precoding matrix W[3] and the slot using the precoding matrix W[4].
Similarly, out of the above-mentioned 1500 slots required to transmit 6000×2 bits, which is the number of bits constituting two coded blocks, when the modulation scheme is 64QAM, 300 slots are necessary for each of the slot using the precoding matrix W[0], the slot using the precoding matrix W[1], the slot using the precoding matrix W[2], the slot using the precoding matrix W[3] and the slot using the precoding matrix W[4].
Also, in order to transmit the first coded block, 300 slots are necessary for each of the slot using the precoding matrix W[0], the slot using the precoding matrix W[1], the slot using the precoding matrix W[2], the slot using the precoding matrix W[3] and the slot using the precoding matrix W[4]. In order to transmit the second coded block, 300 slots are necessary for each of the slot using the precoding matrix W[0], the slot using the precoding matrix W[1], the slot using the precoding matrix W[2], the slot using the precoding matrix W[3] and the slot using the precoding matrix W[4].
Similarly, out of the above-mentioned 1000 slots required to transmit 6000×2 bits, which is the number of bits constituting two coded blocks, when the modulation scheme is 64QAM, 200 slots are necessary for each of the slot using the precoding matrix W[0], the slot using the precoding matrix W[1], the slot using the precoding matrix W[2], the slot using the precoding matrix W[3] and the slot using the precoding matrix W[4].
Also, in order to transmit the first coded block, 200 slots are necessary for each of the slot using the precoding matrix W[0], the slot using the precoding matrix W[1], the slot using the precoding matrix W[2], the slot using the precoding matrix W[3] and the slot using the precoding matrix W[4]. In order to transmit the second coded block, 200 slots are necessary for each of the slot using the precoding matrix W[0], the slot using the precoding matrix W[1], the slot using the precoding matrix W[2], the slot using the precoding matrix W[3] and the slot using the precoding matrix W[4].
As described above, the precoding matrices in the scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices with an N-slot period (cycle) are represented as W[0], W[1], W[2], . . . , W[N−2], W[N−1].
Note that W[0], W[1], W[2], . . . , W[N−2], W[N−1] are composed of at least two or more different precoding matrices (the same precoding matrices may be included in W[0], W[1], W[2], . . . , W[N−2], W[N−1]). When all the bits constituting two coded blocks are transmitted, letting the number of slots using the precoding matrix W[0] be K0, letting the number of slots using the precoding matrix W[1] be K1, letting the number of slots using the precoding matrix W[i] be Ki (i=0, 1, 2, . . . , N−1), and letting the number of slots using the precoding matrix W[N−1] be KN-1, the following condition should be satisfied.
K0=K1= . . . =Ki= . . . =KN-1, i.e., Ka=Kb for ∀a,∀b (a,b=0,1,2, . . . ,N−1 (a,b are integers from 0 to N−1);a≠b) Condition #133
When all the bits constituting the first coded block are transmitted, letting the number of slots using the precoding matrix W[0] be K0, 1, letting the number of slots using the precoding matrix W[1] be K1, 1, letting the number of slots using the precoding matrix W[i] be Ki,1 (i=0, 1, 2, . . . , N−1), and letting the number of slots using the precoding matrix W[N−1] be KN-1, 1, the following condition should be satisfied.
K0,1=K1,1= . . . =Ki,1= . . . =KN-1,1, i.e., Ka,1=Kb,1 for ∀a,∀b (a,b=0,1,2, . . . ,N−1 (a,b are integers from 0 to N−1);a≠b) Condition #134
When all the bits constituting the second coded block are transmitted, letting the number of slots using the precoding matrix W[0] be K0, 2, letting the number of slots using the precoding matrix W[1] be K1, 2, letting the number of slots using the precoding matrix W[i] be Ki,2 (i=0, 1, 2, . . . , N−1), and letting the number of slots using the precoding matrix W[N−1] be KN-1, 2, the following condition should be satisfied.
K0,2=K1,2= . . . =Ki,2= . . . =KN-1,2, i.e., Ka,2=Kb,2 for ∀a,∀b (a,b=0,1,2, . . . ,N−1 (a,b are integers from 0 to N−1);a≠b) Condition #135
When the communication system supports a plurality of modulation schemes, and a modulation scheme is selected and used from among the supported modulation schemes, Condition #133, Condition #134 and Condition #135 should be satisfied.
When the plurality of modulation schemes are supported, however, since the number of bits that one symbol can transmit is generally different depending on modulation schemes (in some cases, the number of bits can be the same), there can be a modulation scheme that is not able to satisfy Condition #133, Condition #134 and Condition #135. In such a case, instead of satisfying Condition #133, Condition #134 and Condition #135, the following condition may be satisfied.
The difference between Ka and Kb is 0 or 1, i.e., |Ka−Kb| is 0 or 1for ∀a,∀b(a,b=0,1,2, . . . ,N−1(a,b are integers from 0 to N−1);a≠b) Condition #136
The difference between Ka,1 and Kb,1 is 0 or 1, i.e., |Ka,1−Kb,1| is 0 or 1for ∀a,∀b(a,b=0,1,2, . . . ,N−1(a,b are integers from 0 to N−1);a≠b) Condition #137
The difference between Ka,2 and Kb,2 is 0 or 1, i.e., |Ka,2−Kb,2| is 0 or 1for ∀a,∀b(a,b=0,1,2, . . . ,N−1(a,b are integers from 0 to N−1);a≠b) Condition #138
By associating the coded blocks with precoding matrices as described above, precoding matrices used to transmit the coded block are unbiased. Therefore, an effect of improving data reception quality in the reception device is obtained.
In the present embodiment, in the scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices, N precoding matrices W[0], W[1], W[2], . . . , W[N−2], W[N−1] are prepared for the precoding hopping scheme with an N-slot period (cycle). There is a way to arrange precoding matrices in the order W[0], W[1], W[2], . . . , W[N−2], W[N−1] in frequency domain. The present invention is not, however, limited in this way. As described in Embodiment 1, precoding weights may be changed by arranging N precoding matrices W[0], W[1], W[2], . . . , W[N−2], W[N−1] generated in the present embodiment in time domain and in the frequency-time domain. Note that a precoding hopping scheme with the N-slot period (cycle) has been described, but the same advantageous effect may be obtained by randomly using N different precoding matrices. In other words, the N different precoding matrices do not need to be used in a regular period (cycle). In this case, when the conditions described in the present embodiment are satisfied, the probability that the reception device achieves excellent data reception quality is high.
As described in Embodiment 15, there are modes such as the spatial multiplexing MIMO system, the MIMO system with a fixed precoding matrix, the space-time block coding scheme, the scheme of transmitting one stream and the scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices. The transmission device (broadcast station, base station) may select one transmission scheme from among these modes. In this case, from among the spatial multiplexing MIMO system, the MIMO system with a fixed precoding matrix, the space-time block coding scheme, the scheme of transmitting one stream and the scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices, a (sub)carrier group selecting the scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices may implement the present embodiment.
In the present description, it is considered that a communication/broadcasting device such as a broadcast station, a base station, an access point, a terminal, a mobile phone, or the like is provided with the transmission device, and that a communication device such as a television, radio, terminal, personal computer, mobile phone, access point, base station, or the like is provided with the reception device. Additionally, it is considered that the transmission device and the reception device in the present invention have a communication function and are capable of being connected via some sort of interface (such as a USB) to a device for executing applications for a television, radio, personal computer, mobile phone, or the like.
Furthermore, in the present embodiment, symbols other than data symbols, such as pilot symbols (preamble, unique word, postamble, reference symbol, and the like), symbols for control information, and the like may be arranged in the frame in any way. While the terms “pilot symbol” and “symbols for control information” have been used here, any term may be used, since the function itself is what is important.
It suffices for a pilot symbol, for example, to be a known symbol modulated with PSK modulation in the transmission and reception devices (or for the reception device to be able to synchronize in order to know the symbol transmitted by the transmission device). The reception device uses this symbol for frequency synchronization, time synchronization, channel estimation (estimation of Channel State Information (CSI) for each modulated signal), detection of signals, and the like.
A symbol for control information is for transmitting information other than data (of applications or the like) that needs to be transmitted to the communication partner for achieving communication (for example, the modulation scheme, error correction coding scheme, coding rate of the error correction coding scheme, setting information in the upper layer, and the like).
Note that the present invention is not limited to the above Embodiments 1-5 and may be embodied with a variety of modifications. For example, the above embodiments describe communication devices, but the present invention is not limited to these devices and may be implemented as software for the corresponding communication scheme.
Furthermore, a precoding hopping scheme used in a scheme of transmitting two modulated signals from two antennas has been described, but the present invention is not limited in this way. The present invention may be also embodied as a precoding hopping scheme for similarly changing precoding weights (matrices) in the context of a scheme whereby four mapped signals are precoded to generate four modulated signals that are transmitted from four antennas, or more generally, whereby N mapped signals are precoded to generate N modulated signals that are transmitted from N antennas.
In the present description, the terms “precoding”, “precoding weight”, “precoding matrix” and the like are used, but any term may be used (such as “codebook”, for example) since the signal processing itself is what is important in the present invention.
Furthermore, in the present description, the reception device has been described as using ML calculation, APP, Max-log APP, ZF, MMSE, or the like, which yields soft decision results (log-likelihood, log-likelihood ratio) or hard decision results (“0” or “1”) for each bit of data transmitted by the transmission device. This process may be referred to as detection, demodulation, estimation, or separation.
Assume that precoded baseband signals z1(i), z2(i) (where i represents the order in terms of time or frequency (carrier)) are generated by precoding baseband signals s1(i) and s2(i) for two streams while regularly hopping between precoding matrices. Let the in-phase component I and the quadrature component Q of the precoded baseband signal z1(i) be I1(i) and Q1(i) respectively, and let the in-phase component I and the quadrature component Q of the precoded baseband signal z2(i) be I2(i) and Q2(i) respectively. In this case, the baseband components may be switched, and modulated signals corresponding to the switched baseband signal r1(i) and the switched baseband signal r2(i) may be transmitted from different antennas at the same time and over the same frequency by transmitting a modulated signal corresponding to the switched baseband signal r1(i) from transmit antenna 1 and a modulated signal corresponding to the switched baseband signal r2(i) from transmit antenna 2 at the same time and over the same frequency. Baseband components may be switched as follows.
In the above-mentioned example, switching between baseband signals at the same time (at the same frequency ((sub)carrier)) has been described, but the present invention is not limited to the switching between baseband signals at the same time. As an example, the following description can be made.
In this case, modulated signals corresponding to the switched baseband signal r1(i) and the switched baseband signal r2(i) may be transmitted from different antennas at the same time and over the same frequency by transmitting a modulated signal corresponding to the switched baseband signal r1 (i) from transmit antenna 1 and a modulated signal corresponding to the switched baseband signal r2(i) from transmit antenna 2 at the same time and over the same frequency.
Each of the transmit antennas of the transmission device and the receive antennas of the reception device shown in the figures may be formed by a plurality of antennas.
In this description, the symbol “∀” represents the universal quantifier, and the symbol “∃” represents the existential quantifier.
Furthermore, in this description, the units of phase, such as argument, in the complex plane are radians.
When using the complex plane, complex numbers may be shown in polar form by polar coordinates. If a complex number z=a+jb (where a and b are real numbers and j is an imaginary unit) corresponds to a point (a, b) on the complex plane, and this point is represented in polar coordinates as [r, θ], then the following math is satisfied.
a=r×cos θ
b=r×sin θ
r=√{square root over (a2+b2)} Math 592
r is the absolute value of z (r=|z|), and θ is the argument. Furthermore, z=a+jb is represented as rejθ.
In the description of the present invention, the baseband signal, modulated signal s1, modulated signal s2, modulated signal z1, and modulated signal z2 are complex signals. Complex signals are represented as I+jQ (where j is an imaginary unit), I being the in-phase signal, and Q being the quadrature signal. In this case, I may be zero, or Q may be zero.
A transmission unit 5907 receives, as input, the data 5902 of the encoded video, the data 5904 of the encoded audio, and the data 5906 of the encoded data, sets some or all of these pieces of data as transmission data, and outputs transmission signals 5908_1 through 5908_N after performing processing such as error correction encoding, modulation, and precoding (for example, the signal processing of the transmission device in
A reception unit 5912 receives, as input, received signals 5911_1 through 5911_M received by antennas 5910_1 through 5910_M, performs processing such as frequency conversion, decoding of precoding, log-likelihood ratio calculation, and error correction decoding (processing by the reception device in
In the above embodiments describing the present invention, the number of encoders in the transmission device when using a multi-carrier transmission scheme such as OFDM may be any number, as described above. Therefore, as in
The symbol arrangement scheme described in Embodiments A1 through A5 and in Embodiment 1 may be similarly implemented as a precoding scheme for regularly hopping between precoding matrices using a plurality of different precoding matrices, the precoding scheme differing from the “scheme for hopping between different precoding matrices” in the present description. The same holds true for other embodiments as well. The following is a supplementary explanation regarding a plurality of different precoding matrices.
Let N precoding matrices be represented as F[0], F[1], F[2], . . . , F[N−3], F[N−2], F[N−1] for a precoding scheme for regularly hopping between precoding matrices. In this case, the “plurality of different precoding matrices” referred to above are assumed to satisfy the following two conditions (Condition *1 and Condition *2).
Math 593
F[x]≠F[y] for ∀x,∀y(x,y=0,1,2, . . . ,N−3,N−2,N−1;x≠y) Condition *1
Here, x is an integer from 0 to N−1, y is an integer from 0 to N−1 and x≠y. With respect to all x and all y satisfying the above, the relationship F[x]≠F[y] holds.
Math 594
F[x]=k×F[y] Condition *2
Letting x be an integer from 0 to N−1, y be an integer from 0 to N−1, and x≠y, for all x and all y, no real or complex number k satisfying the above equation exists.
The following is a supplementary explanation using a 2×2 matrix as an example. Let 2×2 matrices R and S be represented as follows:
Let a=Aejδ11, b=Bejδ12, c=Cejδ21 and d=Dejδ22, and e=Eejγ11, f=Fejγ12, g=Gejγ21 and h=Hejγ22. A, B, C, D, E, F, G, and H are real numbers 0 or greater, and δ11, δ12, δ21, δ22, γ11, γ12, γ21, and γ22 are expressed in radians. In this case, R≠S means that at least one of the following holds: (1) a≠e, (2) b≠f, (3) c≠g and (4) d≠h.
A precoding matrix may be the matrix R wherein one of a, b, c, and d is zero. In other words, the precoding matrix may be such that (1) a is zero, and b, c, and d are not zero; (2) b is zero, and a, c, and d are not zero; (3) c is zero, and a, b, and d are not zero; or (4) d is zero, and a, b, and c are not zero.
In the system example in the description of the present invention, a communication system using a MIMO scheme was described, wherein two modulated signals are transmitted from two antennas and are received by two antennas. The present invention may, however, of course also be adopted in a communication system using a MISO (Multiple Input Single Output) scheme. In the case of the MISO scheme, adoption of a precoding scheme for regularly hopping between a plurality of precoding matrices in the transmission device is the same as described above. On the other hand, the reception device is not provided with the antenna 701_Y, the wireless unit 703_Y, the channel fluctuation estimating unit 707_1 for the modulated signal z1, or the channel fluctuation estimating unit 707_2 for the modulated signal z2 in the structure shown in
Programs for executing the above communication scheme may, for example, be stored in advance in ROM (Read Only Memory) and be caused to operate by a CPU (Central Processing Unit).
Furthermore, the programs for executing the above communication scheme may be stored in a computer-readable recording medium, the programs stored in the recording medium may be loaded in the RAM (Random Access Memory) of the computer, and the computer may be caused to operate in accordance with the programs.
The components in the above embodiments and the like may be typically assembled as an LSI (Large Scale Integration), a type of integrated circuit. Individual components may respectively be made into discrete chips, or part or all of the components in each embodiment may be made into one chip. While an LSI has been referred to, the terms IC (Integrated Circuit), system LSI, super LSI, or ultra LSI may be used depending on the degree of integration. Furthermore, the scheme for assembling integrated circuits is not limited to LSI, and a dedicated circuit or a general-purpose processor may be used. A FPGA (Field Programmable Gate Array), which is programmable after the LSI is manufactured, or a reconfigurable processor, which allows reconfiguration of the connections and settings of circuit cells inside the LSI, may be used.
Furthermore, if technology for forming integrated circuits that replaces LSIs emerges, owing to advances in semiconductor technology or to another derivative technology, the integration of functional blocks may naturally be accomplished using such technology. The application of biotechnology or the like is possible.
With the symbol arranging scheme described in Embodiments A1 through A5 and Embodiment 1, the present invention may be similarly implemented by replacing the “scheme of hopping between different precoding matrices” with a “scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices using a plurality of different precoding matrices”. Note that the “plurality of different precoding matrices” are as described above.
The above describes that “with the symbol arranging scheme described in Embodiments A1 through A5 and Embodiment 1, the present invention may be similarly implemented by replacing the “scheme of hopping between different precoding matrices” with a “scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices using a plurality of different precoding matrices”. As the “scheme of hopping between precoding matrices using a plurality of different precoding matrices”, a scheme of preparing N different precoding matrices described above, and hopping between precoding matrices using the N different precoding matrices with an H-slot period (cycle) (H being a natural number larger than N) may be used (as an example, there is a scheme described in Embodiment C2).
With the symbol arranging scheme described in Embodiment 1, the present invention may be similarly implemented using the precoding scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices described in Embodiments C1 through C5. Similarly, the present invention may be similarly implemented using the precoding scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices described in Embodiments C1 through C5 as the precoding scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices described in Embodiments A1 through A5.
The following describes the scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices described in Non-Patent Literatures 12 through 15 when using a Quasi-Cyclic Low-Density Parity-Check (QC-LDPC) code (or an LDPC code other than a QC-LDPC code), a concatenated code consisting of an LDPC code and a Bose-Chaudhuri-Hocquenghem (BCH) code, and a block code such as a turbo code or a duo-binary turbo code using tail-biting. Note that the present embodiment may be implemented using either a scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices represented by complex numbers or a scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices represented by real numbers, which is described below, as the scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices.
The following describes a case of transmitting two streams s1 and s2 as an example. Note that, when the control information and the like are not required to perform encoding using the block code, the number of bits constituting the coded block is the same as the number of bits constituting the block code (however, the control information and the like described below may be included). When the control information and the like (e.g. CRC (cyclic redundancy check), a transmission parameter) are required to perform encoding using the block code, the number of bits constituting the coded block can be a sum of the number of bits constituting the block code and the number of bits of the control information and the like.
As shown in
Since two streams are to be simultaneously transmitted in the transmission device shown in
Making the same considerations, 750 slots are necessary to transmit all the bits constituting one coded block when the modulation scheme is 16QAM, and 500 slots are necessary to transmit all the bits constituting one block when the modulation scheme is 64QAM.
The present embodiment describes a scheme of initializing precoding matrices in a case where the transmission device in
Next, a case where the transmission device transmits modulated signals each having a frame structure shown in
As shown in
The transmission device transmits the preamble (control symbol) in an interval D. The preamble is a symbol for transmitting control information to the communication partner and is assumed to include information on the modulation scheme for transmitting the third coded block, the fourth coded block and so on. The transmission device is to transmit the third coded block in an interval E. The transmission device is to transmit the fourth coded block in an interval F.
As shown in
The transmission device transmits the preamble (control symbol) in the interval D. The preamble is a symbol for transmitting control information to the communication partner and is assumed to include information on the modulation scheme for transmitting the third coded block, the fourth coded block and so on. The transmission device is to transmit the third coded block in the interval E. The transmission device is to transmit the fourth coded block in the interval F.
Similarly,
As described in this description, a case where phase shift is not performed for the modulated signal z1, i.e. the modulated signal transmitted by the antenna 312A, and is performed for the modulated signal z2, i.e. the modulated signal transmitted by the antenna 312B, is considered. In this case,
First, assume that seven precoding matrices are prepared to regularly hop between the precoding matrices, and are referred to as #0, #1, #2, #3, #4, #5 and #6. The precoding matrices are to be regularly and cyclically used. That is to say, the precoding matrices are to be regularly and cyclically changed in the order #0, #1, #2, #3, #4, #5, #6, #0, #1, #2, #3, #4, #5, #6, #0, #1, #2, #3, #4, #5, #6, . . . .
First, as shown in
Next, the precoding matrices are to be applied to each slot in the second coded block. Since this description is on the assumption that the precoding matrices are applied to the multicast communication and broadcast, one possibility is that a reception terminal does not need the first coded block and extracts only the second coded block. In such a case, even when precoding matrix #0 is used to transmit the last slot in the first coded block, the precoding matrix #1 is used first to transmit the second coded block. In this case, the following two schemes are considered:
(a) The above-mentioned terminal monitors how the first coded block is transmitted, i.e. the terminal monitors a pattern of the precoding matrix used to transmit the last slot in the first coded block, and estimates the precoding matrix to be used to transmit the first slot in the second coded block; and
(b) The transmission device transmits information on the precoding matrix used to transmit the first slot in the second coded block without performing (a).
In the case of (a), since the terminal has to monitor transmission of the first coded block, power consumption increases. In the case of (b), transmission efficiency of data is reduced.
Therefore, there is room for improvement in allocation of precoding matrices as described above. In order to address the above-mentioned problems, a scheme of fixing the precoding matrix used to transmit the first slot in each coded block is proposed. Therefore, as shown in
Similarly, as shown in
With the above-mentioned scheme, an effect of suppressing the problems occurring in (a) and (b) is obtained.
Note that, in the present embodiment, the scheme of initializing the precoding matrices in each coded block, i.e. the scheme in which the precoding matrix used to transmit the first slot in each coded block is fixed to #0, is described. As a different scheme, however, the precoding matrices may be initialized in units of frames. For example, in the symbol for transmitting the preamble and information after transmission of the control symbol, the precoding matrix used in the first slot may be fixed to #0.
For example, in
The following describes a case where the above-mentioned scheme is applied to a broadcasting system that uses the DVB-T2 standard. The frame structure of the broadcasting system that uses the DVB-T2 standard is as described in Embodiments A1 through A3. As described in Embodiments A1 through A3 using
For example, assume that the broadcast station transmits each symbol having the frame structure as shown in
Note that, in the following description, as an example, assume that seven precoding matrices are prepared in the precoding scheme of regularly hopping between the precoding matrices, and are referred to as #0, #1, #2, #3, #4, #5 and #6. The precoding matrices are to be regularly and cyclically used. That is to say, the precoding matrices are to be regularly and cyclically changed in the order #0, #1, #2, #3, #4, #5, #6, #0, #1, #2, #3, #4, #5, #6, #0, #1, #2, #3, #4, #5, #6, . . . .
As shown in
This is to say, in PLP $1, the first slot is the time T and the carrier 3, the second slot is the time T and the carrier 4, the third slot is the time T and a carrier 5, . . . , the seventh slot is a time T+1 and a carrier 1, the eighth slot is the time T+1 and a carrier 2, the ninth slot is the time T+1 and the carrier 3, . . . , the fourteenth slot is the time T+1 and a carrier 8, the fifteenth slot is a time T+2 and a carrier 0, . . . .
The slot (symbol) in PLP $K starts with a time S and a carrier 4 (10203 in
This is to say, in PLP $K, the first slot is the time S and the carrier 4, the second slot is the time S and a carrier 5, the third slot is the time S and a carrier 6, . . . , the fifth slot is the time S and a carrier 8, the ninth slot is a time S+1 and a carrier 1, the tenth slot is the time S+1 and a carrier 2 . . . , the sixteenth slot is the time S+1 and the carrier 8, the seventeenth slot is a time S+2 and a carrier 0, . . . .
Note that information on slot that includes information on the first slot (symbol) and the last slot (symbol) in each PLP and is used by each PLP is transmitted by the control symbol including the P1 symbol, the P2 symbol and the control symbol group.
In this case, as described using
The first slot in another PLP transmitted using the precoding scheme of regularly hopping between the precoding matrices is also precoded using the precoding matrix #0.
With the above-mentioned scheme, an effect of suppressing the above problems occurring in (a) and (b) is obtained.
Naturally, the reception device extracts necessary PLP from the information on slot that is included in the control symbol including the P1 symbol, the P2 symbol and the control symbol group and is used by each PLP to perform demodulation (including separation of signals and signal detection) and error correction decoding. The reception device learns a rule of the precoding scheme of regularly hopping between the precoding matrices in advance (when there are a plurality of rules, the transmission device transmits information on the rule to be used, and the reception device learns the rule being used by obtaining the transmitted information). By synchronizing a timing of rules of hopping the precoding matrices based on the number of the first slot in each PLP, the reception device can perform demodulation of information symbols (including separation of signals and signal detection).
Next, a case where the broadcast station (base station) transmits a modulated signal having a frame structure shown in
In
In this case, as described above, when the above-mentioned precoding scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices is used in the subframe 10301, the first slot in PLP (PLP $1 (10302_1) through PLP $M (10302_M)) is assumed to be precoded using the precoding matrix #0 (referred to as initialization of the precoding matrices). The above-mentioned initialization of precoding matrices, however, is irrelevant to a PLP in which another transmission scheme, for example, one of the transmission scheme using a fixed precoding matrix, the transmission scheme using a spatial multiplexing MIMO system and the transmission scheme using the space-time block coding as described in Embodiments A1 through A3 is used in PLP $1 (10302_1) through PLP $M (10302_M).
As shown in
In this case, the first slot (10201 in
Similarly, the first slot (10401 in
As described above, in each main frame, the first slot in the first PLP in the subframe for transmitting a plurality of modulated signals is characterized by being precoded using the precoding matrix #0.
This is also important to suppress the above-mentioned problems occurring in (a) and (b).
Note that, in the present embodiment, as shown in
In each of the above-mentioned embodiments, the precoding matrices that the weighting combination unit uses for precoding are represented by complex numbers. The precoding matrices may also be represented by real numbers (referred to as a precoding scheme represented by real numbers).
For example, let two mapped baseband signals (in the used modulation scheme) be s1(i) and s2(i) (where i represents time or frequency), and let two precoded baseband signals obtained by the precoding be z1(i) and z2(i). Then, let the in-phase component and the quadrature component of the mapped baseband signal s1(i) (in the used modulation scheme) be Is1(i) and Qs1(i) respectively, the in-phase component and the quadrature component of the mapped baseband signal s2(i) (in the used modulation scheme) be Is2(i) and Qs2(i) respectively, the in-phase component and the quadrature component of the precoded baseband signal z1(i) be Iz1(i) and Qz1(i) respectively, and in-phase component and the quadrature component of the precoded baseband signal z2(i) be Iz2(i) and Qz2(i) respectively. When the precoding matrix composed of real numbers (the precoding matrix represented by real numbers) Hr is used, the following relationship holds.
The precoding matrix composed of real numbers Hr, however, is represented as follows.
Here, a11, a12, a13, a14, a21, a22, a23, a24, a31, a32, a33, a34, a41, a42, a43 and a44 are real numbers. However, {a11=0, a12=0, a13=0 and a14=0} should not hold, {a21=0, a22=0, a23=0 and a24=0} should not hold, {a31=0, a32=0, a33=0 and a34=0} should not hold and {a41=0, a42=0, a43=0 and a44=0} should not hold. Also, {a11=0, a21=0, a31=0 and a41=0} should not hold, {a12=0, a22=0, a32=0 and a42=0} should not hold, {a13=0, a23=0, a33=0 and a43=0} should not hold and {a14=0, a24=0, a34=0 and a44=0} should not hold.
The “scheme of hopping between different precoding matrices” as an application of the precoding scheme of the present invention, such as the symbol arranging scheme described in Embodiments A1 through A5 and Embodiments 1 and 7, may also naturally be implemented as the precoding scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices using the precoding matrices represented by a plurality of different real numbers described as the “precoding scheme represented by real numbers”. The usefulness of hopping between precoding matrices in the present invention is the same as that in a case where the precoding matrices are represented by a plurality of different complex numbers. Note that the “plurality of different precoding matrices” are as described above.
The above describes that “scheme of regularly hopping between different precoding matrices” as an application of the precoding scheme of the present invention, such as the symbol arranging scheme described in Embodiments A1 through A5 and Embodiments 1 and 7, may also naturally be implemented as the precoding scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices using the precoding matrices represented by a plurality of different real numbers described as the “precoding scheme represented by real numbers”. As the “precoding scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices using the precoding matrices represented by a plurality of different real numbers”, a scheme of preparing N different precoding matrices (represented by real numbers), and hopping between precoding matrices using the N different precoding matrices (represented by real numbers) with an H-slot period (cycle) (H being a natural number larger than N) may be used (as an example, there is a scheme described in Embodiment C2).
With the symbol arranging scheme described in Embodiment 1, the present invention may be similarly implemented using the precoding scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices described in Embodiments C1 through C5. Similarly, the present invention may be similarly implemented using the precoding scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices described in Embodiments C1 through C5 as the precoding scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices described in Embodiments A1 through A5.
The present invention is widely applicable to wireless systems that transmit different modulated signals from a plurality of antennas, such as an OFDM-MIMO system. Furthermore, in a wired communication system with a plurality of transmission locations (such as a Power Line Communication (PLC) system, optical communication system, or Digital Subscriber Line (DSL) system), the present invention may be adapted to MIMO, in which case a plurality of transmission locations are used to transmit a plurality of modulated signals as described by the present invention. A modulated signal may also be transmitted from a plurality of transmission locations.
Number | Date | Country | Kind |
---|---|---|---|
2011-035086 | Feb 2011 | JP | national |
Number | Name | Date | Kind |
---|---|---|---|
8971439 | Murakami et al. | Mar 2015 | B2 |
10027390 | Murakami | Jul 2018 | B2 |
20030185309 | Pautler et al. | Oct 2003 | A1 |
20050220199 | Sadowsky et al. | Oct 2005 | A1 |
20070140377 | Murakami et al. | Jun 2007 | A1 |
20080192852 | Kent et al. | Aug 2008 | A1 |
20080232494 | Pan et al. | Sep 2008 | A1 |
20080318606 | Tsutsui et al. | Dec 2008 | A1 |
20090052578 | Sawai | Feb 2009 | A1 |
20090285325 | Zhou | Nov 2009 | A1 |
20100046658 | Yosoku et al. | Feb 2010 | A1 |
20100135203 | Maru | Jun 2010 | A1 |
20100135432 | Miyoshi et al. | Jun 2010 | A1 |
20110007833 | Nakayama | Jan 2011 | A1 |
20110044412 | Murakami et al. | Feb 2011 | A1 |
20110134901 | Hoshino et al. | Jun 2011 | A1 |
20110149945 | Nakao et al. | Jun 2011 | A1 |
20120147989 | Murakami et al. | Jun 2012 | A1 |
20130058239 | Wang et al. | Mar 2013 | A1 |
20130121438 | Murakami et al. | May 2013 | A1 |
20150010104 | Park et al. | Jan 2015 | A1 |
20160269215 | Choi et al. | Sep 2016 | A1 |
20160374060 | Lim et al. | Dec 2016 | A1 |
20170041053 | Murakami | Feb 2017 | A1 |
20170366381 | Zoellner et al. | Dec 2017 | A1 |
Number | Date | Country |
---|---|---|
1502180 | Jun 2004 | CN |
101247157 | Aug 2008 | CN |
101374032 | Feb 2009 | CN |
101636994 | Jan 2010 | CN |
2010016183 | Feb 2010 | CN |
103004118 | Mar 2013 | CN |
2 445 131 | Apr 2012 | EP |
2008-543215 | Nov 2008 | JP |
2009-171155 | Jul 2009 | JP |
2010-514377 | Apr 2010 | JP |
2010-518757 | May 2010 | JP |
02082689 | Oct 2002 | WO |
2005050885 | Jun 2005 | WO |
2006129958 | Dec 2006 | WO |
2008077056 | Jun 2008 | WO |
2008088066 | Jul 2008 | WO |
2008098093 | Aug 2008 | WO |
2009017230 | Feb 2009 | WO |
2009038317 | Mar 2009 | WO |
2010013451 | Feb 2010 | WO |
2011158496 | Dec 2011 | WO |
Entry |
---|
International Search Report dated Mar. 13, 2012 in International (PCT) Application No. PCT/JP2012/001070. |
Al-Naffouri, T.Y.; El-Tayeb, M.E.; “Opportunistic Beamforming with Precoding for Spatially Correlated Channels”, Information Theory, 2009. CWIT 2009. 11th Canadian Workshop on, May 15, 2009. |
“Achieving Near-Capacity on a Multiple-Antenna Channel”, IEEE Transactions on Communications, vol. 51, No. 3, pp. 389-399, Mar. 2003. |
“Performance Analysis and Design Optimization of LDPC-Coded MIMO OFDM Systems”, IEEE Trans. Signal Processing, vol. 52, No. 2, pp. 348-361, Feb. 2004. |
“BER Performance Evaluation in 2×2 MIMO Spatial Multiplexing Systems Under Rician Fading Channels”, IEICE Trans. Fundamentals, vol. E91-A, No. 10, pp. 2798-2807, Oct. 2008. |
“Turbo Space-Time Codes with Time Varying Linear Transformations”, IEEE Trans. Wireless communications, vol. 6, No. 2, pp. 486-493, Feb. 2007. |
“Likelihood Function for QRM-MLD Suitable for Soft-Decision Turbo Decoding and its Performance for OFCDM MIMO Multiplexing in Multipath Fading Channel”, IEICE Trans. Commun., vol. E88-B, No. 1, pp. 47-57, Jan. 2005. |
“A Tutorial on ‘Parallel Concatenated (Turbo) Coding’, ‘Turbo (Iterative) Decoding’ and Related Topics”, The Institute of Electronics, Information, and Communication Engineers, Technical Report IT 98-51. |
“Advanced Signal Processing for PLCs: Wavelet-OFDM”, Proc. of IEEE International symposium on ISPLC 2008, pp. 187-192, 2008. |
D. J. Love, and R. W. Heath, Jr., “Limited Feedback Unitary Precoding for Spatial Multiplexing Systems”, IEEE Trans. Inf. Theory, vol. 51, No. 8, pp. 2967-2976, Aug. 2005. |
DVB Document A122, “Frame Structure, Channel Coding and Modulation for a Second Generation Digital Terrestrial Television Broadcasting System, (DVB-T2)”, Jun. 2008. |
L. Vangelista, N. Benvenuto, and S. Tomasin, “Key Technologies for Next-Generation Terrestrial Digital Television Standard DVB-T2”, IEEE Commun. Magazine, vol. 47, No. 10, pp. 146-153, Oct. 2009. |
T. Ohgane, T. Nishimura, and Y. Ogawa, “Applications of Space Division Multiplexing and Those Performance in a MIMO Channel”, IEICE Trans. Commun., vol. E88-B, No. 5, pp. 1843-1851, May 2005. |
R. G. Gallager, “Low-Density Parity-Check Codes”, IRE Trans. Inform. Theory, IT-8, pp. 21-28, 1962. |
D. J. C. Mackay, “Good Error-Correcting Codes Based on Very Sparse Matrices”, IEEE Trans. Inform. Theory, vol. 45, No. 2, pp. 399-431, Mar. 1999. |
“Second Generation Framing Structure, Channel Coding and Modulation Systems for Broadcasting, Interactive Services, News Gathering and Other Broadband Satellite Applications”, v. 1.1.2, Jun. 2006. |
Y.-L. Ueng, and C.-C. Cheng, “A Fast-Convergence Decoding Method and Memory-Efficient VLSI Decoder Architecture for Irregular LDPC codes in the IEEE 802.16e Standards”, IEEE VTC-2007 Fall, pp. 1255-1259. |
Sandell, M.; Beng Sin Lee;, “Pseudo-Random Scrambling for Quasi-Static MIMO Channels, Personal, Indoor and Mobile Radio Communications”, 2007. PIMRC 2007. IEEE 18th International Symposium on, Sep. 7, 2007. |
Kobayashi K. et al.: “MIMO System with Relative Phase Difference Time-Shift Modulation for Rician Fading Environment”, IEICE Transactions on Communications, Communications Society, Tokyo, JP, vol. E91B, No. 2, Feb. 1, 2008 (Feb. 1, 2008), pp. 459-465 [XP001511247]. |
Kobayashi K. et al.: “MIMO System with Relative Phase Difference Time-Shift Modulation in Rician Fading Environments”, IEEE International Conference on Communications, 2008: ICC'08; May 19-23, 2008, Beijing, China, IEEE, Piscataway, NJ, USA, May 19, 2008 (May 19, 2008), pp. 732-736 [XP031265464]. |
Murakami Y. et al.: “Design of Transmission Technique Utilizing Linear Combination Diversity in Consideration of Los Environments in MIMO Systems”, IEICE Transactions on Fundamentals of Electronics, Communications and Computer Sciences, Engineering Sciences Society, Tokyo, JP, vol. E88-A, No. 11, Nov. 1, 2005 (Nov. 1, 2005), pp. 3127-3133 [XP001236654]. |
J. Klutto Milleth, Giridhar K. et al.: “Performance Enhancement of Space-Time Trellis Codes When Encountering AWGN and Ricean Channels”, IEEE Transactions on Vehicular Technology, IEEE Service Center, Piscataway, NJ, US, vol. 54, No. 4, Jul. 1, 2005 (Jul. 1, 2005), pp. 1352-1360 [XP011137369]. |
Office Action dated Dec. 3, 2014 in Chinese Application No. 201180029416.0, with Partial English translation. |
International Search Report dated Jul. 12, 2011 in International (PCT) Application No. PCT/JP2011/003384. |
Supplementary European Search Report dated Mar. 15, 2012 in European Application No. EP11795404.0. |
Office Action dated Jun. 30, 2015 in Chinese Application No. 201280009614.5, with partial English translation. |
Office Action dated Mar. 8, 2017 in Taiwanese Application No. 105110908, with partial English translation. |
NTT DoCoMo et al., Downlink MIMO Scheme for Shared Data Channel in E-UTRA, 3GPP TSG RAN WGI Meeting No. 47 RI-063310, Nov. 10, 2006. |
Notice of Allowance dated Sep. 28, 2018 in U.S. Appl. No. 15/804,209. |
Office Action dated Nov. 28, 2018 in European Application No. 17 201 238.7. |
Notice of Allowance dated Dec. 18, 2018 in U.S. Appl. No. 15/804,209. |
Office Action dated Feb. 3, 2019 in Chinese Application No. 201610621531.1, with partial English translation. |
Office Action dated Sep. 18, 2019 in U.S. Appl. No. 16/353,208. |
Number | Date | Country | |
---|---|---|---|
20190288753 A1 | Sep 2019 | US |
Number | Date | Country | |
---|---|---|---|
Parent | 16004674 | Jun 2018 | US |
Child | 16432085 | US | |
Parent | 15692030 | Aug 2017 | US |
Child | 16004674 | US | |
Parent | 15389494 | Dec 2016 | US |
Child | 15692030 | US | |
Parent | 14939292 | Nov 2015 | US |
Child | 15389494 | US | |
Parent | 14582652 | Dec 2014 | US |
Child | 14939292 | US | |
Parent | 13985707 | US | |
Child | 14582652 | US |